Merge from the pain train
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / config / mips / mips.c
blobacd6ae0a704f270768071d2884d118223825f050
1 /* Subroutines used for MIPS code generation.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 1990, 1991, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998,
3 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 Contributed by A. Lichnewsky, lich@inria.inria.fr.
5 Changes by Michael Meissner, meissner@osf.org.
6 64 bit r4000 support by Ian Lance Taylor, ian@cygnus.com, and
7 Brendan Eich, brendan@microunity.com.
9 This file is part of GCC.
11 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
12 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
13 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
14 any later version.
16 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
17 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
18 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
19 GNU General Public License for more details.
21 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
22 along with GCC; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
23 the Free Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
24 Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
26 #include "config.h"
27 #include "system.h"
28 #include "coretypes.h"
29 #include "tm.h"
30 #include <signal.h>
31 #include "rtl.h"
32 #include "regs.h"
33 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
34 #include "real.h"
35 #include "insn-config.h"
36 #include "conditions.h"
37 #include "insn-attr.h"
38 #include "recog.h"
39 #include "toplev.h"
40 #include "output.h"
41 #include "tree.h"
42 #include "function.h"
43 #include "expr.h"
44 #include "optabs.h"
45 #include "flags.h"
46 #include "reload.h"
47 #include "tm_p.h"
48 #include "ggc.h"
49 #include "gstab.h"
50 #include "hashtab.h"
51 #include "debug.h"
52 #include "target.h"
53 #include "target-def.h"
54 #include "integrate.h"
55 #include "langhooks.h"
56 #include "cfglayout.h"
57 #include "sched-int.h"
58 #include "tree-gimple.h"
60 /* True if X is an unspec wrapper around a SYMBOL_REF or LABEL_REF. */
61 #define UNSPEC_ADDRESS_P(X) \
62 (GET_CODE (X) == UNSPEC \
63 && XINT (X, 1) >= UNSPEC_ADDRESS_FIRST \
64 && XINT (X, 1) < UNSPEC_ADDRESS_FIRST + NUM_SYMBOL_TYPES)
66 /* Extract the symbol or label from UNSPEC wrapper X. */
67 #define UNSPEC_ADDRESS(X) \
68 XVECEXP (X, 0, 0)
70 /* Extract the symbol type from UNSPEC wrapper X. */
71 #define UNSPEC_ADDRESS_TYPE(X) \
72 ((enum mips_symbol_type) (XINT (X, 1) - UNSPEC_ADDRESS_FIRST))
74 /* The maximum distance between the top of the stack frame and the
75 value $sp has when we save & restore registers.
77 Use a maximum gap of 0x100 in the mips16 case. We can then use
78 unextended instructions to save and restore registers, and to
79 allocate and deallocate the top part of the frame.
81 The value in the !mips16 case must be a SMALL_OPERAND and must
82 preserve the maximum stack alignment. */
83 #define MIPS_MAX_FIRST_STACK_STEP (TARGET_MIPS16 ? 0x100 : 0x7ff0)
85 /* True if INSN is a mips.md pattern or asm statement. */
86 #define USEFUL_INSN_P(INSN) \
87 (INSN_P (INSN) \
88 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (INSN)) != USE \
89 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (INSN)) != CLOBBER \
90 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (INSN)) != ADDR_VEC \
91 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (INSN)) != ADDR_DIFF_VEC)
93 /* If INSN is a delayed branch sequence, return the first instruction
94 in the sequence, otherwise return INSN itself. */
95 #define SEQ_BEGIN(INSN) \
96 (INSN_P (INSN) && GET_CODE (PATTERN (INSN)) == SEQUENCE \
97 ? XVECEXP (PATTERN (INSN), 0, 0) \
98 : (INSN))
100 /* Likewise for the last instruction in a delayed branch sequence. */
101 #define SEQ_END(INSN) \
102 (INSN_P (INSN) && GET_CODE (PATTERN (INSN)) == SEQUENCE \
103 ? XVECEXP (PATTERN (INSN), 0, XVECLEN (PATTERN (INSN), 0) - 1) \
104 : (INSN))
106 /* Execute the following loop body with SUBINSN set to each instruction
107 between SEQ_BEGIN (INSN) and SEQ_END (INSN) inclusive. */
108 #define FOR_EACH_SUBINSN(SUBINSN, INSN) \
109 for ((SUBINSN) = SEQ_BEGIN (INSN); \
110 (SUBINSN) != NEXT_INSN (SEQ_END (INSN)); \
111 (SUBINSN) = NEXT_INSN (SUBINSN))
113 /* Classifies an address.
115 ADDRESS_REG
116 A natural register + offset address. The register satisfies
117 mips_valid_base_register_p and the offset is a const_arith_operand.
119 ADDRESS_LO_SUM
120 A LO_SUM rtx. The first operand is a valid base register and
121 the second operand is a symbolic address.
123 ADDRESS_CONST_INT
124 A signed 16-bit constant address.
126 ADDRESS_SYMBOLIC:
127 A constant symbolic address (equivalent to CONSTANT_SYMBOLIC). */
128 enum mips_address_type {
129 ADDRESS_REG,
130 ADDRESS_LO_SUM,
131 ADDRESS_CONST_INT,
132 ADDRESS_SYMBOLIC
135 /* Classifies the prototype of a builtin function. */
136 enum mips_function_type
138 MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_V2SF,
139 MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_V2SF_V2SF,
140 MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_V2SF_V2SF_INT,
141 MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_V2SF_V2SF_V2SF_V2SF,
142 MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_SF_SF,
143 MIPS_INT_FTYPE_V2SF_V2SF,
144 MIPS_INT_FTYPE_V2SF_V2SF_V2SF_V2SF,
145 MIPS_INT_FTYPE_SF_SF,
146 MIPS_INT_FTYPE_DF_DF,
147 MIPS_SF_FTYPE_V2SF,
148 MIPS_SF_FTYPE_SF,
149 MIPS_SF_FTYPE_SF_SF,
150 MIPS_DF_FTYPE_DF,
151 MIPS_DF_FTYPE_DF_DF,
153 /* The last type. */
154 MIPS_MAX_FTYPE_MAX
157 /* Specifies how a builtin function should be converted into rtl. */
158 enum mips_builtin_type
160 /* The builtin corresponds directly to an .md pattern. The return
161 value is mapped to operand 0 and the arguments are mapped to
162 operands 1 and above. */
163 MIPS_BUILTIN_DIRECT,
165 /* The builtin corresponds to a comparison instruction followed by
166 a mips_cond_move_tf_ps pattern. The first two arguments are the
167 values to compare and the second two arguments are the vector
168 operands for the movt.ps or movf.ps instruction (in assembly order). */
169 MIPS_BUILTIN_MOVF,
170 MIPS_BUILTIN_MOVT,
172 /* The builtin corresponds to a V2SF comparison instruction. Operand 0
173 of this instruction is the result of the comparison, which has mode
174 CCV2 or CCV4. The function arguments are mapped to operands 1 and
175 above. The function's return value is an SImode boolean that is
176 true under the following conditions:
178 MIPS_BUILTIN_CMP_ANY: one of the registers is true
179 MIPS_BUILTIN_CMP_ALL: all of the registers are true
180 MIPS_BUILTIN_CMP_LOWER: the first register is true
181 MIPS_BUILTIN_CMP_UPPER: the second register is true. */
182 MIPS_BUILTIN_CMP_ANY,
183 MIPS_BUILTIN_CMP_ALL,
184 MIPS_BUILTIN_CMP_UPPER,
185 MIPS_BUILTIN_CMP_LOWER,
187 /* As above, but the instruction only sets a single $fcc register. */
188 MIPS_BUILTIN_CMP_SINGLE
191 /* Invokes MACRO (COND) for each c.cond.fmt condition. */
192 #define MIPS_FP_CONDITIONS(MACRO) \
193 MACRO (f), \
194 MACRO (un), \
195 MACRO (eq), \
196 MACRO (ueq), \
197 MACRO (olt), \
198 MACRO (ult), \
199 MACRO (ole), \
200 MACRO (ule), \
201 MACRO (sf), \
202 MACRO (ngle), \
203 MACRO (seq), \
204 MACRO (ngl), \
205 MACRO (lt), \
206 MACRO (nge), \
207 MACRO (le), \
208 MACRO (ngt)
210 /* Enumerates the codes above as MIPS_FP_COND_<X>. */
211 #define DECLARE_MIPS_COND(X) MIPS_FP_COND_ ## X
212 enum mips_fp_condition {
213 MIPS_FP_CONDITIONS (DECLARE_MIPS_COND)
216 /* Index X provides the string representation of MIPS_FP_COND_<X>. */
217 #define STRINGIFY(X) #X
218 static const char *const mips_fp_conditions[] = {
219 MIPS_FP_CONDITIONS (STRINGIFY)
222 /* A function to save or store a register. The first argument is the
223 register and the second is the stack slot. */
224 typedef void (*mips_save_restore_fn) (rtx, rtx);
226 struct mips16_constant;
227 struct mips_arg_info;
228 struct mips_address_info;
229 struct mips_integer_op;
230 struct mips_sim;
232 static enum mips_symbol_type mips_classify_symbol (rtx);
233 static void mips_split_const (rtx, rtx *, HOST_WIDE_INT *);
234 static bool mips_offset_within_object_p (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT);
235 static bool mips_valid_base_register_p (rtx, enum machine_mode, int);
236 static bool mips_symbolic_address_p (enum mips_symbol_type, enum machine_mode);
237 static bool mips_classify_address (struct mips_address_info *, rtx,
238 enum machine_mode, int);
239 static int mips_symbol_insns (enum mips_symbol_type);
240 static bool mips16_unextended_reference_p (enum machine_mode mode, rtx, rtx);
241 static rtx mips_force_temporary (rtx, rtx);
242 static rtx mips_split_symbol (rtx, rtx);
243 static rtx mips_unspec_offset_high (rtx, rtx, rtx, enum mips_symbol_type);
244 static rtx mips_add_offset (rtx, rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT);
245 static unsigned int mips_build_shift (struct mips_integer_op *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
246 static unsigned int mips_build_lower (struct mips_integer_op *,
247 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
248 static unsigned int mips_build_integer (struct mips_integer_op *,
249 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
250 static void mips_move_integer (rtx, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
251 static void mips_legitimize_const_move (enum machine_mode, rtx, rtx);
252 static int m16_check_op (rtx, int, int, int);
253 static bool mips_rtx_costs (rtx, int, int, int *);
254 static int mips_address_cost (rtx);
255 static void mips_emit_compare (enum rtx_code *, rtx *, rtx *, bool);
256 static void mips_load_call_address (rtx, rtx, int);
257 static bool mips_function_ok_for_sibcall (tree, tree);
258 static void mips_block_move_straight (rtx, rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT);
259 static void mips_adjust_block_mem (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT, rtx *, rtx *);
260 static void mips_block_move_loop (rtx, rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT);
261 static void mips_arg_info (const CUMULATIVE_ARGS *, enum machine_mode,
262 tree, int, struct mips_arg_info *);
263 static bool mips_get_unaligned_mem (rtx *, unsigned int, int, rtx *, rtx *);
264 static void mips_set_architecture (const struct mips_cpu_info *);
265 static void mips_set_tune (const struct mips_cpu_info *);
266 static struct machine_function *mips_init_machine_status (void);
267 static void print_operand_reloc (FILE *, rtx, const char **);
268 #if TARGET_IRIX
269 static void irix_output_external_libcall (rtx);
270 #endif
271 static void mips_file_start (void);
272 static void mips_file_end (void);
273 static bool mips_rewrite_small_data_p (rtx);
274 static int mips_small_data_pattern_1 (rtx *, void *);
275 static int mips_rewrite_small_data_1 (rtx *, void *);
276 static bool mips_function_has_gp_insn (void);
277 static unsigned int mips_global_pointer (void);
278 static bool mips_save_reg_p (unsigned int);
279 static void mips_save_restore_reg (enum machine_mode, int, HOST_WIDE_INT,
280 mips_save_restore_fn);
281 static void mips_for_each_saved_reg (HOST_WIDE_INT, mips_save_restore_fn);
282 static void mips_output_cplocal (void);
283 static void mips_emit_loadgp (void);
284 static void mips_output_function_prologue (FILE *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
285 static void mips_set_frame_expr (rtx);
286 static rtx mips_frame_set (rtx, rtx);
287 static void mips_save_reg (rtx, rtx);
288 static void mips_output_function_epilogue (FILE *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
289 static void mips_restore_reg (rtx, rtx);
290 static void mips_output_mi_thunk (FILE *, tree, HOST_WIDE_INT,
291 HOST_WIDE_INT, tree);
292 static int symbolic_expression_p (rtx);
293 static void mips_select_rtx_section (enum machine_mode, rtx,
294 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
295 static void mips_function_rodata_section (tree);
296 static bool mips_in_small_data_p (tree);
297 static int mips_fpr_return_fields (tree, tree *);
298 static bool mips_return_in_msb (tree);
299 static rtx mips_return_fpr_pair (enum machine_mode mode,
300 enum machine_mode mode1, HOST_WIDE_INT,
301 enum machine_mode mode2, HOST_WIDE_INT);
302 static rtx mips16_gp_pseudo_reg (void);
303 static void mips16_fp_args (FILE *, int, int);
304 static void build_mips16_function_stub (FILE *);
305 static rtx dump_constants_1 (enum machine_mode, rtx, rtx);
306 static void dump_constants (struct mips16_constant *, rtx);
307 static int mips16_insn_length (rtx);
308 static int mips16_rewrite_pool_refs (rtx *, void *);
309 static void mips16_lay_out_constants (void);
310 static void mips_sim_reset (struct mips_sim *);
311 static void mips_sim_init (struct mips_sim *, state_t);
312 static void mips_sim_next_cycle (struct mips_sim *);
313 static void mips_sim_wait_reg (struct mips_sim *, rtx, rtx);
314 static int mips_sim_wait_regs_2 (rtx *, void *);
315 static void mips_sim_wait_regs_1 (rtx *, void *);
316 static void mips_sim_wait_regs (struct mips_sim *, rtx);
317 static void mips_sim_wait_units (struct mips_sim *, rtx);
318 static void mips_sim_wait_insn (struct mips_sim *, rtx);
319 static void mips_sim_record_set (rtx, rtx, void *);
320 static void mips_sim_issue_insn (struct mips_sim *, rtx);
321 static void mips_sim_issue_nop (struct mips_sim *);
322 static void mips_sim_finish_insn (struct mips_sim *, rtx);
323 static void vr4130_avoid_branch_rt_conflict (rtx);
324 static void vr4130_align_insns (void);
325 static void mips_avoid_hazard (rtx, rtx, int *, rtx *, rtx);
326 static void mips_avoid_hazards (void);
327 static void mips_reorg (void);
328 static bool mips_strict_matching_cpu_name_p (const char *, const char *);
329 static bool mips_matching_cpu_name_p (const char *, const char *);
330 static const struct mips_cpu_info *mips_parse_cpu (const char *, const char *);
331 static const struct mips_cpu_info *mips_cpu_info_from_isa (int);
332 static bool mips_return_in_memory (tree, tree);
333 static bool mips_strict_argument_naming (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *);
334 static void mips_macc_chains_record (rtx);
335 static void mips_macc_chains_reorder (rtx *, int);
336 static void vr4130_true_reg_dependence_p_1 (rtx, rtx, void *);
337 static bool vr4130_true_reg_dependence_p (rtx);
338 static bool vr4130_swap_insns_p (rtx, rtx);
339 static void vr4130_reorder (rtx *, int);
340 static void mips_promote_ready (rtx *, int, int);
341 static int mips_sched_reorder (FILE *, int, rtx *, int *, int);
342 static int mips_variable_issue (FILE *, int, rtx, int);
343 static int mips_adjust_cost (rtx, rtx, rtx, int);
344 static int mips_issue_rate (void);
345 static int mips_multipass_dfa_lookahead (void);
346 static void mips_init_libfuncs (void);
347 static void mips_setup_incoming_varargs (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *, enum machine_mode,
348 tree, int *, int);
349 static tree mips_build_builtin_va_list (void);
350 static tree mips_gimplify_va_arg_expr (tree, tree, tree *, tree *);
351 static bool mips_pass_by_reference (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *, enum machine_mode mode,
352 tree, bool);
353 static bool mips_callee_copies (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *, enum machine_mode mode,
354 tree, bool);
355 static int mips_arg_partial_bytes (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *, enum machine_mode mode,
356 tree, bool);
357 static bool mips_valid_pointer_mode (enum machine_mode);
358 static bool mips_scalar_mode_supported_p (enum machine_mode);
359 static bool mips_vector_mode_supported_p (enum machine_mode);
360 static rtx mips_prepare_builtin_arg (enum insn_code, unsigned int, tree *);
361 static rtx mips_prepare_builtin_target (enum insn_code, unsigned int, rtx);
362 static rtx mips_expand_builtin (tree, rtx, rtx, enum machine_mode, int);
363 static void mips_init_builtins (void);
364 static rtx mips_expand_builtin_direct (enum insn_code, rtx, tree);
365 static rtx mips_expand_builtin_movtf (enum mips_builtin_type,
366 enum insn_code, enum mips_fp_condition,
367 rtx, tree);
368 static rtx mips_expand_builtin_compare (enum mips_builtin_type,
369 enum insn_code, enum mips_fp_condition,
370 rtx, tree);
372 /* Structure to be filled in by compute_frame_size with register
373 save masks, and offsets for the current function. */
375 struct mips_frame_info GTY(())
377 HOST_WIDE_INT total_size; /* # bytes that the entire frame takes up */
378 HOST_WIDE_INT var_size; /* # bytes that variables take up */
379 HOST_WIDE_INT args_size; /* # bytes that outgoing arguments take up */
380 HOST_WIDE_INT cprestore_size; /* # bytes that the .cprestore slot takes up */
381 HOST_WIDE_INT gp_reg_size; /* # bytes needed to store gp regs */
382 HOST_WIDE_INT fp_reg_size; /* # bytes needed to store fp regs */
383 unsigned int mask; /* mask of saved gp registers */
384 unsigned int fmask; /* mask of saved fp registers */
385 HOST_WIDE_INT gp_save_offset; /* offset from vfp to store gp registers */
386 HOST_WIDE_INT fp_save_offset; /* offset from vfp to store fp registers */
387 HOST_WIDE_INT gp_sp_offset; /* offset from new sp to store gp registers */
388 HOST_WIDE_INT fp_sp_offset; /* offset from new sp to store fp registers */
389 bool initialized; /* true if frame size already calculated */
390 int num_gp; /* number of gp registers saved */
391 int num_fp; /* number of fp registers saved */
394 struct machine_function GTY(()) {
395 /* Pseudo-reg holding the value of $28 in a mips16 function which
396 refers to GP relative global variables. */
397 rtx mips16_gp_pseudo_rtx;
399 /* Current frame information, calculated by compute_frame_size. */
400 struct mips_frame_info frame;
402 /* The register to use as the global pointer within this function. */
403 unsigned int global_pointer;
405 /* True if mips_adjust_insn_length should ignore an instruction's
406 hazard attribute. */
407 bool ignore_hazard_length_p;
409 /* True if the whole function is suitable for .set noreorder and
410 .set nomacro. */
411 bool all_noreorder_p;
413 /* True if the function is known to have an instruction that needs $gp. */
414 bool has_gp_insn_p;
417 /* Information about a single argument. */
418 struct mips_arg_info
420 /* True if the argument is passed in a floating-point register, or
421 would have been if we hadn't run out of registers. */
422 bool fpr_p;
424 /* The number of words passed in registers, rounded up. */
425 unsigned int reg_words;
427 /* For EABI, the offset of the first register from GP_ARG_FIRST or
428 FP_ARG_FIRST. For other ABIs, the offset of the first register from
429 the start of the ABI's argument structure (see the CUMULATIVE_ARGS
430 comment for details).
432 The value is MAX_ARGS_IN_REGISTERS if the argument is passed entirely
433 on the stack. */
434 unsigned int reg_offset;
436 /* The number of words that must be passed on the stack, rounded up. */
437 unsigned int stack_words;
439 /* The offset from the start of the stack overflow area of the argument's
440 first stack word. Only meaningful when STACK_WORDS is nonzero. */
441 unsigned int stack_offset;
445 /* Information about an address described by mips_address_type.
447 ADDRESS_CONST_INT
448 No fields are used.
450 ADDRESS_REG
451 REG is the base register and OFFSET is the constant offset.
453 ADDRESS_LO_SUM
454 REG is the register that contains the high part of the address,
455 OFFSET is the symbolic address being referenced and SYMBOL_TYPE
456 is the type of OFFSET's symbol.
458 ADDRESS_SYMBOLIC
459 SYMBOL_TYPE is the type of symbol being referenced. */
461 struct mips_address_info
463 enum mips_address_type type;
464 rtx reg;
465 rtx offset;
466 enum mips_symbol_type symbol_type;
470 /* One stage in a constant building sequence. These sequences have
471 the form:
473 A = VALUE[0]
474 A = A CODE[1] VALUE[1]
475 A = A CODE[2] VALUE[2]
478 where A is an accumulator, each CODE[i] is a binary rtl operation
479 and each VALUE[i] is a constant integer. */
480 struct mips_integer_op {
481 enum rtx_code code;
482 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value;
486 /* The largest number of operations needed to load an integer constant.
487 The worst accepted case for 64-bit constants is LUI,ORI,SLL,ORI,SLL,ORI.
488 When the lowest bit is clear, we can try, but reject a sequence with
489 an extra SLL at the end. */
490 #define MIPS_MAX_INTEGER_OPS 7
493 /* Global variables for machine-dependent things. */
495 /* Threshold for data being put into the small data/bss area, instead
496 of the normal data area. */
497 int mips_section_threshold = -1;
499 /* Count the number of .file directives, so that .loc is up to date. */
500 int num_source_filenames = 0;
502 /* Count the number of sdb related labels are generated (to find block
503 start and end boundaries). */
504 int sdb_label_count = 0;
506 /* Next label # for each statement for Silicon Graphics IRIS systems. */
507 int sym_lineno = 0;
509 /* Linked list of all externals that are to be emitted when optimizing
510 for the global pointer if they haven't been declared by the end of
511 the program with an appropriate .comm or initialization. */
513 struct extern_list GTY (())
515 struct extern_list *next; /* next external */
516 const char *name; /* name of the external */
517 int size; /* size in bytes */
520 static GTY (()) struct extern_list *extern_head = 0;
522 /* Name of the file containing the current function. */
523 const char *current_function_file = "";
525 /* Number of nested .set noreorder, noat, nomacro, and volatile requests. */
526 int set_noreorder;
527 int set_noat;
528 int set_nomacro;
529 int set_volatile;
531 /* The next branch instruction is a branch likely, not branch normal. */
532 int mips_branch_likely;
534 /* The operands passed to the last cmpMM expander. */
535 rtx cmp_operands[2];
537 /* The target cpu for code generation. */
538 enum processor_type mips_arch;
539 const struct mips_cpu_info *mips_arch_info;
541 /* The target cpu for optimization and scheduling. */
542 enum processor_type mips_tune;
543 const struct mips_cpu_info *mips_tune_info;
545 /* Which instruction set architecture to use. */
546 int mips_isa;
548 /* Which ABI to use. */
549 int mips_abi;
551 /* Strings to hold which cpu and instruction set architecture to use. */
552 const char *mips_arch_string; /* for -march=<xxx> */
553 const char *mips_tune_string; /* for -mtune=<xxx> */
554 const char *mips_isa_string; /* for -mips{1,2,3,4} */
555 const char *mips_abi_string; /* for -mabi={32,n32,64,eabi} */
557 /* Whether we are generating mips16 hard float code. In mips16 mode
558 we always set TARGET_SOFT_FLOAT; this variable is nonzero if
559 -msoft-float was not specified by the user, which means that we
560 should arrange to call mips32 hard floating point code. */
561 int mips16_hard_float;
563 const char *mips_cache_flush_func = CACHE_FLUSH_FUNC;
565 /* If TRUE, we split addresses into their high and low parts in the RTL. */
566 int mips_split_addresses;
568 /* Mode used for saving/restoring general purpose registers. */
569 static enum machine_mode gpr_mode;
571 /* Array giving truth value on whether or not a given hard register
572 can support a given mode. */
573 char mips_hard_regno_mode_ok[(int)MAX_MACHINE_MODE][FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
575 /* List of all MIPS punctuation characters used by print_operand. */
576 char mips_print_operand_punct[256];
578 /* Map GCC register number to debugger register number. */
579 int mips_dbx_regno[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
581 /* A copy of the original flag_delayed_branch: see override_options. */
582 static int mips_flag_delayed_branch;
584 static GTY (()) int mips_output_filename_first_time = 1;
586 /* mips_split_p[X] is true if symbols of type X can be split by
587 mips_split_symbol(). */
588 static bool mips_split_p[NUM_SYMBOL_TYPES];
590 /* mips_lo_relocs[X] is the relocation to use when a symbol of type X
591 appears in a LO_SUM. It can be null if such LO_SUMs aren't valid or
592 if they are matched by a special .md file pattern. */
593 static const char *mips_lo_relocs[NUM_SYMBOL_TYPES];
595 /* Likewise for HIGHs. */
596 static const char *mips_hi_relocs[NUM_SYMBOL_TYPES];
598 /* Map hard register number to register class */
599 const enum reg_class mips_regno_to_class[] =
601 LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS, M16_NA_REGS, M16_NA_REGS,
602 M16_REGS, M16_REGS, M16_REGS, M16_REGS,
603 LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS,
604 LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS,
605 M16_NA_REGS, M16_NA_REGS, LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS,
606 LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS,
607 T_REG, PIC_FN_ADDR_REG, LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS,
608 LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS, LEA_REGS,
609 FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS,
610 FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS,
611 FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS,
612 FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS,
613 FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS,
614 FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS,
615 FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS,
616 FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS, FP_REGS,
617 HI_REG, LO_REG, NO_REGS, ST_REGS,
618 ST_REGS, ST_REGS, ST_REGS, ST_REGS,
619 ST_REGS, ST_REGS, ST_REGS, NO_REGS,
620 NO_REGS, ALL_REGS, ALL_REGS, NO_REGS,
621 COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS,
622 COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS,
623 COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS,
624 COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS,
625 COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS,
626 COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS,
627 COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS,
628 COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS, COP0_REGS,
629 COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS,
630 COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS,
631 COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS,
632 COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS,
633 COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS,
634 COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS,
635 COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS,
636 COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS, COP2_REGS,
637 COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS,
638 COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS,
639 COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS,
640 COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS,
641 COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS,
642 COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS,
643 COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS,
644 COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS, COP3_REGS
647 /* Map register constraint character to register class. */
648 enum reg_class mips_char_to_class[256];
650 /* A table describing all the processors gcc knows about. Names are
651 matched in the order listed. The first mention of an ISA level is
652 taken as the canonical name for that ISA.
654 To ease comparison, please keep this table in the same order as
655 gas's mips_cpu_info_table[]. */
656 const struct mips_cpu_info mips_cpu_info_table[] = {
657 /* Entries for generic ISAs */
658 { "mips1", PROCESSOR_R3000, 1 },
659 { "mips2", PROCESSOR_R6000, 2 },
660 { "mips3", PROCESSOR_R4000, 3 },
661 { "mips4", PROCESSOR_R8000, 4 },
662 { "mips32", PROCESSOR_4KC, 32 },
663 { "mips32r2", PROCESSOR_M4K, 33 },
664 { "mips64", PROCESSOR_5KC, 64 },
666 /* MIPS I */
667 { "r3000", PROCESSOR_R3000, 1 },
668 { "r2000", PROCESSOR_R3000, 1 }, /* = r3000 */
669 { "r3900", PROCESSOR_R3900, 1 },
671 /* MIPS II */
672 { "r6000", PROCESSOR_R6000, 2 },
674 /* MIPS III */
675 { "r4000", PROCESSOR_R4000, 3 },
676 { "vr4100", PROCESSOR_R4100, 3 },
677 { "vr4111", PROCESSOR_R4111, 3 },
678 { "vr4120", PROCESSOR_R4120, 3 },
679 { "vr4130", PROCESSOR_R4130, 3 },
680 { "vr4300", PROCESSOR_R4300, 3 },
681 { "r4400", PROCESSOR_R4000, 3 }, /* = r4000 */
682 { "r4600", PROCESSOR_R4600, 3 },
683 { "orion", PROCESSOR_R4600, 3 }, /* = r4600 */
684 { "r4650", PROCESSOR_R4650, 3 },
686 /* MIPS IV */
687 { "r8000", PROCESSOR_R8000, 4 },
688 { "vr5000", PROCESSOR_R5000, 4 },
689 { "vr5400", PROCESSOR_R5400, 4 },
690 { "vr5500", PROCESSOR_R5500, 4 },
691 { "rm7000", PROCESSOR_R7000, 4 },
692 { "rm9000", PROCESSOR_R9000, 4 },
694 /* MIPS32 */
695 { "4kc", PROCESSOR_4KC, 32 },
696 { "4kp", PROCESSOR_4KC, 32 }, /* = 4kc */
698 /* MIPS32 Release 2 */
699 { "m4k", PROCESSOR_M4K, 33 },
701 /* MIPS64 */
702 { "5kc", PROCESSOR_5KC, 64 },
703 { "20kc", PROCESSOR_20KC, 64 },
704 { "sb1", PROCESSOR_SB1, 64 },
705 { "sr71000", PROCESSOR_SR71000, 64 },
707 /* End marker */
708 { 0, 0, 0 }
711 /* Nonzero if -march should decide the default value of MASK_SOFT_FLOAT. */
712 #ifndef MIPS_MARCH_CONTROLS_SOFT_FLOAT
713 #define MIPS_MARCH_CONTROLS_SOFT_FLOAT 0
714 #endif
716 /* Initialize the GCC target structure. */
717 #undef TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
718 #define TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP "\t.half\t"
719 #undef TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
720 #define TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP "\t.word\t"
721 #undef TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
722 #define TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP "\t.dword\t"
724 #undef TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE
725 #define TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE mips_output_function_prologue
726 #undef TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE
727 #define TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE mips_output_function_epilogue
728 #undef TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION
729 #define TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION mips_select_rtx_section
730 #undef TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION
731 #define TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION mips_function_rodata_section
733 #undef TARGET_SCHED_REORDER
734 #define TARGET_SCHED_REORDER mips_sched_reorder
735 #undef TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE
736 #define TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE mips_variable_issue
737 #undef TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST
738 #define TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST mips_adjust_cost
739 #undef TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE
740 #define TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE mips_issue_rate
741 #undef TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD
742 #define TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD \
743 mips_multipass_dfa_lookahead
745 #undef TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
746 #define TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL mips_function_ok_for_sibcall
748 #undef TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE
749 #define TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE mips_valid_pointer_mode
750 #undef TARGET_RTX_COSTS
751 #define TARGET_RTX_COSTS mips_rtx_costs
752 #undef TARGET_ADDRESS_COST
753 #define TARGET_ADDRESS_COST mips_address_cost
755 #undef TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P
756 #define TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P mips_in_small_data_p
758 #undef TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
759 #define TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG mips_reorg
761 #undef TARGET_ASM_FILE_START
762 #undef TARGET_ASM_FILE_END
763 #define TARGET_ASM_FILE_START mips_file_start
764 #define TARGET_ASM_FILE_END mips_file_end
765 #undef TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
766 #define TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE true
768 #undef TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS
769 #define TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS mips_init_libfuncs
771 #undef TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST
772 #define TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST mips_build_builtin_va_list
773 #undef TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR
774 #define TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR mips_gimplify_va_arg_expr
776 #undef TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS
777 #define TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS hook_bool_tree_true
778 #undef TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN
779 #define TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN hook_bool_tree_true
780 #undef TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
781 #define TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES hook_bool_tree_true
783 #undef TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY
784 #define TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY mips_return_in_memory
785 #undef TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB
786 #define TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB mips_return_in_msb
788 #undef TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
789 #define TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK mips_output_mi_thunk
790 #undef TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
791 #define TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK hook_bool_tree_hwi_hwi_tree_true
793 #undef TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
794 #define TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS mips_setup_incoming_varargs
795 #undef TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
796 #define TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING mips_strict_argument_naming
797 #undef TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
798 #define TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK must_pass_in_stack_var_size
799 #undef TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
800 #define TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE mips_pass_by_reference
801 #undef TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES
802 #define TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES mips_callee_copies
803 #undef TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES
804 #define TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES mips_arg_partial_bytes
806 #undef TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
807 #define TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P mips_vector_mode_supported_p
809 #undef TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
810 #define TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P mips_scalar_mode_supported_p
812 #undef TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS
813 #define TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS mips_init_builtins
814 #undef TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN
815 #define TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN mips_expand_builtin
817 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
819 /* Classify symbol X, which must be a SYMBOL_REF or a LABEL_REF. */
821 static enum mips_symbol_type
822 mips_classify_symbol (rtx x)
824 if (GET_CODE (x) == LABEL_REF)
826 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
827 return SYMBOL_CONSTANT_POOL;
828 if (TARGET_ABICALLS)
829 return SYMBOL_GOT_LOCAL;
830 return SYMBOL_GENERAL;
833 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF);
835 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (x))
837 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
838 return SYMBOL_CONSTANT_POOL;
840 if (TARGET_ABICALLS)
841 return SYMBOL_GOT_LOCAL;
843 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (get_pool_mode (x)) <= mips_section_threshold)
844 return SYMBOL_SMALL_DATA;
846 return SYMBOL_GENERAL;
849 if (SYMBOL_REF_SMALL_P (x))
850 return SYMBOL_SMALL_DATA;
852 if (TARGET_ABICALLS)
854 if (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (x) == 0)
855 return SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (x) ? SYMBOL_GOT_LOCAL : SYMBOL_GOT_GLOBAL;
857 /* There are three cases to consider:
859 - o32 PIC (either with or without explicit relocs)
860 - n32/n64 PIC without explicit relocs
861 - n32/n64 PIC with explicit relocs
863 In the first case, both local and global accesses will use an
864 R_MIPS_GOT16 relocation. We must correctly predict which of
865 the two semantics (local or global) the assembler and linker
866 will apply. The choice doesn't depend on the symbol's
867 visibility, so we deliberately ignore decl_visibility and
868 binds_local_p here.
870 In the second case, the assembler will not use R_MIPS_GOT16
871 relocations, but it chooses between local and global accesses
872 in the same way as for o32 PIC.
874 In the third case we have more freedom since both forms of
875 access will work for any kind of symbol. However, there seems
876 little point in doing things differently. */
877 if (DECL_P (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (x)) && TREE_PUBLIC (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (x)))
878 return SYMBOL_GOT_GLOBAL;
880 return SYMBOL_GOT_LOCAL;
883 return SYMBOL_GENERAL;
887 /* Split X into a base and a constant offset, storing them in *BASE
888 and *OFFSET respectively. */
890 static void
891 mips_split_const (rtx x, rtx *base, HOST_WIDE_INT *offset)
893 *offset = 0;
895 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST)
896 x = XEXP (x, 0);
898 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT)
900 *offset += INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1));
901 x = XEXP (x, 0);
903 *base = x;
907 /* Return true if SYMBOL is a SYMBOL_REF and OFFSET + SYMBOL points
908 to the same object as SYMBOL. */
910 static bool
911 mips_offset_within_object_p (rtx symbol, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
913 if (GET_CODE (symbol) != SYMBOL_REF)
914 return false;
916 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (symbol)
917 && offset >= 0
918 && offset < (int) GET_MODE_SIZE (get_pool_mode (symbol)))
919 return true;
921 if (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (symbol) != 0
922 && offset >= 0
923 && offset < int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (symbol))))
924 return true;
926 return false;
930 /* Return true if X is a symbolic constant that can be calculated in
931 the same way as a bare symbol. If it is, store the type of the
932 symbol in *SYMBOL_TYPE. */
934 bool
935 mips_symbolic_constant_p (rtx x, enum mips_symbol_type *symbol_type)
937 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
939 mips_split_const (x, &x, &offset);
940 if (UNSPEC_ADDRESS_P (x))
941 *symbol_type = UNSPEC_ADDRESS_TYPE (x);
942 else if (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF || GET_CODE (x) == LABEL_REF)
943 *symbol_type = mips_classify_symbol (x);
944 else
945 return false;
947 if (offset == 0)
948 return true;
950 /* Check whether a nonzero offset is valid for the underlying
951 relocations. */
952 switch (*symbol_type)
954 case SYMBOL_GENERAL:
955 case SYMBOL_64_HIGH:
956 case SYMBOL_64_MID:
957 case SYMBOL_64_LOW:
958 /* If the target has 64-bit pointers and the object file only
959 supports 32-bit symbols, the values of those symbols will be
960 sign-extended. In this case we can't allow an arbitrary offset
961 in case the 32-bit value X + OFFSET has a different sign from X. */
962 if (Pmode == DImode && !ABI_HAS_64BIT_SYMBOLS)
963 return mips_offset_within_object_p (x, offset);
965 /* In other cases the relocations can handle any offset. */
966 return true;
968 case SYMBOL_CONSTANT_POOL:
969 /* Allow constant pool references to be converted to LABEL+CONSTANT.
970 In this case, we no longer have access to the underlying constant,
971 but the original symbol-based access was known to be valid. */
972 if (GET_CODE (x) == LABEL_REF)
973 return true;
975 /* Fall through. */
977 case SYMBOL_SMALL_DATA:
978 /* Make sure that the offset refers to something within the
979 underlying object. This should guarantee that the final
980 PC- or GP-relative offset is within the 16-bit limit. */
981 return mips_offset_within_object_p (x, offset);
983 case SYMBOL_GOT_LOCAL:
984 case SYMBOL_GOTOFF_PAGE:
985 /* The linker should provide enough local GOT entries for a
986 16-bit offset. Larger offsets may lead to GOT overflow. */
987 return SMALL_OPERAND (offset);
989 case SYMBOL_GOT_GLOBAL:
990 case SYMBOL_GOTOFF_GLOBAL:
991 case SYMBOL_GOTOFF_CALL:
992 case SYMBOL_GOTOFF_LOADGP:
993 return false;
995 gcc_unreachable ();
999 /* Return true if X is a symbolic constant whose value is not split
1000 into separate relocations. */
1002 bool
1003 mips_atomic_symbolic_constant_p (rtx x)
1005 enum mips_symbol_type type;
1006 return mips_symbolic_constant_p (x, &type) && !mips_split_p[type];
1010 /* This function is used to implement REG_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P. */
1013 mips_regno_mode_ok_for_base_p (int regno, enum machine_mode mode, int strict)
1015 if (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1017 if (!strict)
1018 return true;
1019 regno = reg_renumber[regno];
1022 /* These fake registers will be eliminated to either the stack or
1023 hard frame pointer, both of which are usually valid base registers.
1024 Reload deals with the cases where the eliminated form isn't valid. */
1025 if (regno == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM || regno == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
1026 return true;
1028 /* In mips16 mode, the stack pointer can only address word and doubleword
1029 values, nothing smaller. There are two problems here:
1031 (a) Instantiating virtual registers can introduce new uses of the
1032 stack pointer. If these virtual registers are valid addresses,
1033 the stack pointer should be too.
1035 (b) Most uses of the stack pointer are not made explicit until
1036 FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM and ARG_POINTER_REGNUM have been eliminated.
1037 We don't know until that stage whether we'll be eliminating to the
1038 stack pointer (which needs the restriction) or the hard frame
1039 pointer (which doesn't).
1041 All in all, it seems more consistent to only enforce this restriction
1042 during and after reload. */
1043 if (TARGET_MIPS16 && regno == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1044 return !strict || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 4 || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 8;
1046 return TARGET_MIPS16 ? M16_REG_P (regno) : GP_REG_P (regno);
1050 /* Return true if X is a valid base register for the given mode.
1051 Allow only hard registers if STRICT. */
1053 static bool
1054 mips_valid_base_register_p (rtx x, enum machine_mode mode, int strict)
1056 if (!strict && GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG)
1057 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
1059 return (REG_P (x)
1060 && mips_regno_mode_ok_for_base_p (REGNO (x), mode, strict));
1064 /* Return true if symbols of type SYMBOL_TYPE can directly address a value
1065 with mode MODE. This is used for both symbolic and LO_SUM addresses. */
1067 static bool
1068 mips_symbolic_address_p (enum mips_symbol_type symbol_type,
1069 enum machine_mode mode)
1071 switch (symbol_type)
1073 case SYMBOL_GENERAL:
1074 return !TARGET_MIPS16;
1076 case SYMBOL_SMALL_DATA:
1077 return true;
1079 case SYMBOL_CONSTANT_POOL:
1080 /* PC-relative addressing is only available for lw and ld. */
1081 return GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 4 || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 8;
1083 case SYMBOL_GOT_LOCAL:
1084 return true;
1086 case SYMBOL_GOT_GLOBAL:
1087 /* The address will have to be loaded from the GOT first. */
1088 return false;
1090 case SYMBOL_GOTOFF_PAGE:
1091 case SYMBOL_GOTOFF_GLOBAL:
1092 case SYMBOL_GOTOFF_CALL:
1093 case SYMBOL_GOTOFF_LOADGP:
1094 case SYMBOL_64_HIGH:
1095 case SYMBOL_64_MID:
1096 case SYMBOL_64_LOW:
1097 return true;
1099 gcc_unreachable ();
1103 /* Return true if X is a valid address for machine mode MODE. If it is,
1104 fill in INFO appropriately. STRICT is true if we should only accept
1105 hard base registers. */
1107 static bool
1108 mips_classify_address (struct mips_address_info *info, rtx x,
1109 enum machine_mode mode, int strict)
1111 switch (GET_CODE (x))
1113 case REG:
1114 case SUBREG:
1115 info->type = ADDRESS_REG;
1116 info->reg = x;
1117 info->offset = const0_rtx;
1118 return mips_valid_base_register_p (info->reg, mode, strict);
1120 case PLUS:
1121 info->type = ADDRESS_REG;
1122 info->reg = XEXP (x, 0);
1123 info->offset = XEXP (x, 1);
1124 return (mips_valid_base_register_p (info->reg, mode, strict)
1125 && const_arith_operand (info->offset, VOIDmode));
1127 case LO_SUM:
1128 info->type = ADDRESS_LO_SUM;
1129 info->reg = XEXP (x, 0);
1130 info->offset = XEXP (x, 1);
1131 return (mips_valid_base_register_p (info->reg, mode, strict)
1132 && mips_symbolic_constant_p (info->offset, &info->symbol_type)
1133 && mips_symbolic_address_p (info->symbol_type, mode)
1134 && mips_lo_relocs[info->symbol_type] != 0);
1136 case CONST_INT:
1137 /* Small-integer addresses don't occur very often, but they
1138 are legitimate if $0 is a valid base register. */
1139 info->type = ADDRESS_CONST_INT;
1140 return !TARGET_MIPS16 && SMALL_INT (x);
1142 case CONST:
1143 case LABEL_REF:
1144 case SYMBOL_REF:
1145 info->type = ADDRESS_SYMBOLIC;
1146 return (mips_symbolic_constant_p (x, &info->symbol_type)
1147 && mips_symbolic_address_p (info->symbol_type, mode)
1148 && !mips_split_p[info->symbol_type]);
1150 default:
1151 return false;
1155 /* Return the number of instructions needed to load a symbol of the
1156 given type into a register. If valid in an address, the same number
1157 of instructions are needed for loads and stores. Treat extended
1158 mips16 instructions as two instructions. */
1160 static int
1161 mips_symbol_insns (enum mips_symbol_type type)
1163 switch (type)
1165 case SYMBOL_GENERAL:
1166 /* In mips16 code, general symbols must be fetched from the
1167 constant pool. */
1168 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
1169 return 0;
1171 /* When using 64-bit symbols, we need 5 preparatory instructions,
1172 such as:
1174 lui $at,%highest(symbol)
1175 daddiu $at,$at,%higher(symbol)
1176 dsll $at,$at,16
1177 daddiu $at,$at,%hi(symbol)
1178 dsll $at,$at,16
1180 The final address is then $at + %lo(symbol). With 32-bit
1181 symbols we just need a preparatory lui. */
1182 return (ABI_HAS_64BIT_SYMBOLS ? 6 : 2);
1184 case SYMBOL_SMALL_DATA:
1185 return 1;
1187 case SYMBOL_CONSTANT_POOL:
1188 /* This case is for mips16 only. Assume we'll need an
1189 extended instruction. */
1190 return 2;
1192 case SYMBOL_GOT_LOCAL:
1193 case SYMBOL_GOT_GLOBAL:
1194 /* Unless -funit-at-a-time is in effect, we can't be sure whether
1195 the local/global classification is accurate. See override_options
1196 for details.
1198 The worst cases are:
1200 (1) For local symbols when generating o32 or o64 code. The assembler
1201 will use:
1203 lw $at,%got(symbol)
1206 ...and the final address will be $at + %lo(symbol).
1208 (2) For global symbols when -mxgot. The assembler will use:
1210 lui $at,%got_hi(symbol)
1211 (d)addu $at,$at,$gp
1213 ...and the final address will be $at + %got_lo(symbol). */
1214 return 3;
1216 case SYMBOL_GOTOFF_PAGE:
1217 case SYMBOL_GOTOFF_GLOBAL:
1218 case SYMBOL_GOTOFF_CALL:
1219 case SYMBOL_GOTOFF_LOADGP:
1220 case SYMBOL_64_HIGH:
1221 case SYMBOL_64_MID:
1222 case SYMBOL_64_LOW:
1223 /* Check whether the offset is a 16- or 32-bit value. */
1224 return mips_split_p[type] ? 2 : 1;
1226 gcc_unreachable ();
1229 /* Return true if X is a legitimate $sp-based address for mode MDOE. */
1231 bool
1232 mips_stack_address_p (rtx x, enum machine_mode mode)
1234 struct mips_address_info addr;
1236 return (mips_classify_address (&addr, x, mode, false)
1237 && addr.type == ADDRESS_REG
1238 && addr.reg == stack_pointer_rtx);
1241 /* Return true if a value at OFFSET bytes from BASE can be accessed
1242 using an unextended mips16 instruction. MODE is the mode of the
1243 value.
1245 Usually the offset in an unextended instruction is a 5-bit field.
1246 The offset is unsigned and shifted left once for HIs, twice
1247 for SIs, and so on. An exception is SImode accesses off the
1248 stack pointer, which have an 8-bit immediate field. */
1250 static bool
1251 mips16_unextended_reference_p (enum machine_mode mode, rtx base, rtx offset)
1253 if (TARGET_MIPS16
1254 && GET_CODE (offset) == CONST_INT
1255 && INTVAL (offset) >= 0
1256 && (INTVAL (offset) & (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - 1)) == 0)
1258 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 4 && base == stack_pointer_rtx)
1259 return INTVAL (offset) < 256 * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1260 return INTVAL (offset) < 32 * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1262 return false;
1266 /* Return the number of instructions needed to load or store a value
1267 of mode MODE at X. Return 0 if X isn't valid for MODE.
1269 For mips16 code, count extended instructions as two instructions. */
1272 mips_address_insns (rtx x, enum machine_mode mode)
1274 struct mips_address_info addr;
1275 int factor;
1277 if (mode == BLKmode)
1278 /* BLKmode is used for single unaligned loads and stores. */
1279 factor = 1;
1280 else
1281 /* Each word of a multi-word value will be accessed individually. */
1282 factor = (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
1284 if (mips_classify_address (&addr, x, mode, false))
1285 switch (addr.type)
1287 case ADDRESS_REG:
1288 if (TARGET_MIPS16
1289 && !mips16_unextended_reference_p (mode, addr.reg, addr.offset))
1290 return factor * 2;
1291 return factor;
1293 case ADDRESS_LO_SUM:
1294 return (TARGET_MIPS16 ? factor * 2 : factor);
1296 case ADDRESS_CONST_INT:
1297 return factor;
1299 case ADDRESS_SYMBOLIC:
1300 return factor * mips_symbol_insns (addr.symbol_type);
1302 return 0;
1306 /* Likewise for constant X. */
1309 mips_const_insns (rtx x)
1311 struct mips_integer_op codes[MIPS_MAX_INTEGER_OPS];
1312 enum mips_symbol_type symbol_type;
1313 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1315 switch (GET_CODE (x))
1317 case HIGH:
1318 if (TARGET_MIPS16
1319 || !mips_symbolic_constant_p (XEXP (x, 0), &symbol_type)
1320 || !mips_split_p[symbol_type])
1321 return 0;
1323 return 1;
1325 case CONST_INT:
1326 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
1327 /* Unsigned 8-bit constants can be loaded using an unextended
1328 LI instruction. Unsigned 16-bit constants can be loaded
1329 using an extended LI. Negative constants must be loaded
1330 using LI and then negated. */
1331 return (INTVAL (x) >= 0 && INTVAL (x) < 256 ? 1
1332 : SMALL_OPERAND_UNSIGNED (INTVAL (x)) ? 2
1333 : INTVAL (x) > -256 && INTVAL (x) < 0 ? 2
1334 : SMALL_OPERAND_UNSIGNED (-INTVAL (x)) ? 3
1335 : 0);
1337 return mips_build_integer (codes, INTVAL (x));
1339 case CONST_DOUBLE:
1340 case CONST_VECTOR:
1341 return (!TARGET_MIPS16 && x == CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (x)) ? 1 : 0);
1343 case CONST:
1344 if (CONST_GP_P (x))
1345 return 1;
1347 /* See if we can refer to X directly. */
1348 if (mips_symbolic_constant_p (x, &symbol_type))
1349 return mips_symbol_insns (symbol_type);
1351 /* Otherwise try splitting the constant into a base and offset.
1352 16-bit offsets can be added using an extra addiu. Larger offsets
1353 must be calculated separately and then added to the base. */
1354 mips_split_const (x, &x, &offset);
1355 if (offset != 0)
1357 int n = mips_const_insns (x);
1358 if (n != 0)
1360 if (SMALL_OPERAND (offset))
1361 return n + 1;
1362 else
1363 return n + 1 + mips_build_integer (codes, offset);
1366 return 0;
1368 case SYMBOL_REF:
1369 case LABEL_REF:
1370 return mips_symbol_insns (mips_classify_symbol (x));
1372 default:
1373 return 0;
1378 /* Return the number of instructions needed for memory reference X.
1379 Count extended mips16 instructions as two instructions. */
1382 mips_fetch_insns (rtx x)
1384 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x));
1385 return mips_address_insns (XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (x));
1389 /* Return the number of instructions needed for an integer division. */
1392 mips_idiv_insns (void)
1394 int count;
1396 count = 1;
1397 if (TARGET_CHECK_ZERO_DIV)
1399 if (GENERATE_DIVIDE_TRAPS)
1400 count++;
1401 else
1402 count += 2;
1405 if (TARGET_FIX_R4000 || TARGET_FIX_R4400)
1406 count++;
1407 return count;
1410 /* This function is used to implement GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS. It
1411 returns a nonzero value if X is a legitimate address for a memory
1412 operand of the indicated MODE. STRICT is nonzero if this function
1413 is called during reload. */
1415 bool
1416 mips_legitimate_address_p (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, int strict)
1418 struct mips_address_info addr;
1420 return mips_classify_address (&addr, x, mode, strict);
1424 /* Copy VALUE to a register and return that register. If new psuedos
1425 are allowed, copy it into a new register, otherwise use DEST. */
1427 static rtx
1428 mips_force_temporary (rtx dest, rtx value)
1430 if (!no_new_pseudos)
1431 return force_reg (Pmode, value);
1432 else
1434 emit_move_insn (copy_rtx (dest), value);
1435 return dest;
1440 /* Return a LO_SUM expression for ADDR. TEMP is as for mips_force_temporary
1441 and is used to load the high part into a register. */
1443 static rtx
1444 mips_split_symbol (rtx temp, rtx addr)
1446 rtx high;
1448 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
1449 high = mips16_gp_pseudo_reg ();
1450 else
1451 high = mips_force_temporary (temp, gen_rtx_HIGH (Pmode, copy_rtx (addr)));
1452 return gen_rtx_LO_SUM (Pmode, high, addr);
1456 /* Return an UNSPEC address with underlying address ADDRESS and symbol
1457 type SYMBOL_TYPE. */
1460 mips_unspec_address (rtx address, enum mips_symbol_type symbol_type)
1462 rtx base;
1463 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1465 mips_split_const (address, &base, &offset);
1466 base = gen_rtx_UNSPEC (Pmode, gen_rtvec (1, base),
1467 UNSPEC_ADDRESS_FIRST + symbol_type);
1468 return plus_constant (gen_rtx_CONST (Pmode, base), offset);
1472 /* If mips_unspec_address (ADDR, SYMBOL_TYPE) is a 32-bit value, add the
1473 high part to BASE and return the result. Just return BASE otherwise.
1474 TEMP is available as a temporary register if needed.
1476 The returned expression can be used as the first operand to a LO_SUM. */
1478 static rtx
1479 mips_unspec_offset_high (rtx temp, rtx base, rtx addr,
1480 enum mips_symbol_type symbol_type)
1482 if (mips_split_p[symbol_type])
1484 addr = gen_rtx_HIGH (Pmode, mips_unspec_address (addr, symbol_type));
1485 addr = mips_force_temporary (temp, addr);
1486 return mips_force_temporary (temp, gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, addr, base));
1488 return base;
1492 /* Return a legitimate address for REG + OFFSET. TEMP is as for
1493 mips_force_temporary; it is only needed when OFFSET is not a
1494 SMALL_OPERAND. */
1496 static rtx
1497 mips_add_offset (rtx temp, rtx reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1499 if (!SMALL_OPERAND (offset))
1501 rtx high;
1502 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
1504 /* Load the full offset into a register so that we can use
1505 an unextended instruction for the address itself. */
1506 high = GEN_INT (offset);
1507 offset = 0;
1509 else
1511 /* Leave OFFSET as a 16-bit offset and put the excess in HIGH. */
1512 high = GEN_INT (CONST_HIGH_PART (offset));
1513 offset = CONST_LOW_PART (offset);
1515 high = mips_force_temporary (temp, high);
1516 reg = mips_force_temporary (temp, gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, high, reg));
1518 return plus_constant (reg, offset);
1522 /* This function is used to implement LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS. If *XLOC can
1523 be legitimized in a way that the generic machinery might not expect,
1524 put the new address in *XLOC and return true. MODE is the mode of
1525 the memory being accessed. */
1527 bool
1528 mips_legitimize_address (rtx *xloc, enum machine_mode mode)
1530 enum mips_symbol_type symbol_type;
1532 /* See if the address can split into a high part and a LO_SUM. */
1533 if (mips_symbolic_constant_p (*xloc, &symbol_type)
1534 && mips_symbolic_address_p (symbol_type, mode)
1535 && mips_split_p[symbol_type])
1537 *xloc = mips_split_symbol (0, *xloc);
1538 return true;
1541 if (GET_CODE (*xloc) == PLUS && GET_CODE (XEXP (*xloc, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1543 /* Handle REG + CONSTANT using mips_add_offset. */
1544 rtx reg;
1546 reg = XEXP (*xloc, 0);
1547 if (!mips_valid_base_register_p (reg, mode, 0))
1548 reg = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, reg);
1549 *xloc = mips_add_offset (0, reg, INTVAL (XEXP (*xloc, 1)));
1550 return true;
1553 return false;
1557 /* Subroutine of mips_build_integer (with the same interface).
1558 Assume that the final action in the sequence should be a left shift. */
1560 static unsigned int
1561 mips_build_shift (struct mips_integer_op *codes, HOST_WIDE_INT value)
1563 unsigned int i, shift;
1565 /* Shift VALUE right until its lowest bit is set. Shift arithmetically
1566 since signed numbers are easier to load than unsigned ones. */
1567 shift = 0;
1568 while ((value & 1) == 0)
1569 value /= 2, shift++;
1571 i = mips_build_integer (codes, value);
1572 codes[i].code = ASHIFT;
1573 codes[i].value = shift;
1574 return i + 1;
1578 /* As for mips_build_shift, but assume that the final action will be
1579 an IOR or PLUS operation. */
1581 static unsigned int
1582 mips_build_lower (struct mips_integer_op *codes, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value)
1584 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT high;
1585 unsigned int i;
1587 high = value & ~(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 0xffff;
1588 if (!LUI_OPERAND (high) && (value & 0x18000) == 0x18000)
1590 /* The constant is too complex to load with a simple lui/ori pair
1591 so our goal is to clear as many trailing zeros as possible.
1592 In this case, we know bit 16 is set and that the low 16 bits
1593 form a negative number. If we subtract that number from VALUE,
1594 we will clear at least the lowest 17 bits, maybe more. */
1595 i = mips_build_integer (codes, CONST_HIGH_PART (value));
1596 codes[i].code = PLUS;
1597 codes[i].value = CONST_LOW_PART (value);
1599 else
1601 i = mips_build_integer (codes, high);
1602 codes[i].code = IOR;
1603 codes[i].value = value & 0xffff;
1605 return i + 1;
1609 /* Fill CODES with a sequence of rtl operations to load VALUE.
1610 Return the number of operations needed. */
1612 static unsigned int
1613 mips_build_integer (struct mips_integer_op *codes,
1614 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value)
1616 if (SMALL_OPERAND (value)
1617 || SMALL_OPERAND_UNSIGNED (value)
1618 || LUI_OPERAND (value))
1620 /* The value can be loaded with a single instruction. */
1621 codes[0].code = UNKNOWN;
1622 codes[0].value = value;
1623 return 1;
1625 else if ((value & 1) != 0 || LUI_OPERAND (CONST_HIGH_PART (value)))
1627 /* Either the constant is a simple LUI/ORI combination or its
1628 lowest bit is set. We don't want to shift in this case. */
1629 return mips_build_lower (codes, value);
1631 else if ((value & 0xffff) == 0)
1633 /* The constant will need at least three actions. The lowest
1634 16 bits are clear, so the final action will be a shift. */
1635 return mips_build_shift (codes, value);
1637 else
1639 /* The final action could be a shift, add or inclusive OR.
1640 Rather than use a complex condition to select the best
1641 approach, try both mips_build_shift and mips_build_lower
1642 and pick the one that gives the shortest sequence.
1643 Note that this case is only used once per constant. */
1644 struct mips_integer_op alt_codes[MIPS_MAX_INTEGER_OPS];
1645 unsigned int cost, alt_cost;
1647 cost = mips_build_shift (codes, value);
1648 alt_cost = mips_build_lower (alt_codes, value);
1649 if (alt_cost < cost)
1651 memcpy (codes, alt_codes, alt_cost * sizeof (codes[0]));
1652 cost = alt_cost;
1654 return cost;
1659 /* Move VALUE into register DEST. */
1661 static void
1662 mips_move_integer (rtx dest, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value)
1664 struct mips_integer_op codes[MIPS_MAX_INTEGER_OPS];
1665 enum machine_mode mode;
1666 unsigned int i, cost;
1667 rtx x;
1669 mode = GET_MODE (dest);
1670 cost = mips_build_integer (codes, value);
1672 /* Apply each binary operation to X. Invariant: X is a legitimate
1673 source operand for a SET pattern. */
1674 x = GEN_INT (codes[0].value);
1675 for (i = 1; i < cost; i++)
1677 if (no_new_pseudos)
1678 emit_move_insn (dest, x), x = dest;
1679 else
1680 x = force_reg (mode, x);
1681 x = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (codes[i].code, mode, x, GEN_INT (codes[i].value));
1684 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, x));
1688 /* Subroutine of mips_legitimize_move. Move constant SRC into register
1689 DEST given that SRC satisfies immediate_operand but doesn't satisfy
1690 move_operand. */
1692 static void
1693 mips_legitimize_const_move (enum machine_mode mode, rtx dest, rtx src)
1695 rtx base;
1696 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1697 enum mips_symbol_type symbol_type;
1699 /* Split moves of big integers into smaller pieces. In mips16 code,
1700 it's better to force the constant into memory instead. */
1701 if (GET_CODE (src) == CONST_INT && !TARGET_MIPS16)
1703 mips_move_integer (dest, INTVAL (src));
1704 return;
1707 /* See if the symbol can be split. For mips16, this is often worse than
1708 forcing it in the constant pool since it needs the single-register form
1709 of addiu or daddiu. */
1710 if (!TARGET_MIPS16
1711 && mips_symbolic_constant_p (src, &symbol_type)
1712 && mips_split_p[symbol_type])
1714 emit_move_insn (dest, mips_split_symbol (dest, src));
1715 return;
1718 /* If we have (const (plus symbol offset)), load the symbol first
1719 and then add in the offset. This is usually better than forcing
1720 the constant into memory, at least in non-mips16 code. */
1721 mips_split_const (src, &base, &offset);
1722 if (!TARGET_MIPS16
1723 && offset != 0
1724 && (!no_new_pseudos || SMALL_OPERAND (offset)))
1726 base = mips_force_temporary (dest, base);
1727 emit_move_insn (dest, mips_add_offset (0, base, offset));
1728 return;
1731 src = force_const_mem (mode, src);
1733 /* When using explicit relocs, constant pool references are sometimes
1734 not legitimate addresses. */
1735 if (!memory_operand (src, VOIDmode))
1736 src = replace_equiv_address (src, mips_split_symbol (dest, XEXP (src, 0)));
1737 emit_move_insn (dest, src);
1741 /* If (set DEST SRC) is not a valid instruction, emit an equivalent
1742 sequence that is valid. */
1744 bool
1745 mips_legitimize_move (enum machine_mode mode, rtx dest, rtx src)
1747 if (!register_operand (dest, mode) && !reg_or_0_operand (src, mode))
1749 emit_move_insn (dest, force_reg (mode, src));
1750 return true;
1753 /* Check for individual, fully-reloaded mflo and mfhi instructions. */
1754 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= UNITS_PER_WORD
1755 && REG_P (src) && MD_REG_P (REGNO (src))
1756 && REG_P (dest) && GP_REG_P (REGNO (dest)))
1758 int other_regno = REGNO (src) == HI_REGNUM ? LO_REGNUM : HI_REGNUM;
1759 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= 4)
1760 emit_insn (gen_mfhilo_si (gen_rtx_REG (SImode, REGNO (dest)),
1761 gen_rtx_REG (SImode, REGNO (src)),
1762 gen_rtx_REG (SImode, other_regno)));
1763 else
1764 emit_insn (gen_mfhilo_di (gen_rtx_REG (DImode, REGNO (dest)),
1765 gen_rtx_REG (DImode, REGNO (src)),
1766 gen_rtx_REG (DImode, other_regno)));
1767 return true;
1770 /* We need to deal with constants that would be legitimate
1771 immediate_operands but not legitimate move_operands. */
1772 if (CONSTANT_P (src) && !move_operand (src, mode))
1774 mips_legitimize_const_move (mode, dest, src);
1775 set_unique_reg_note (get_last_insn (), REG_EQUAL, copy_rtx (src));
1776 return true;
1778 return false;
1781 /* We need a lot of little routines to check constant values on the
1782 mips16. These are used to figure out how long the instruction will
1783 be. It would be much better to do this using constraints, but
1784 there aren't nearly enough letters available. */
1786 static int
1787 m16_check_op (rtx op, int low, int high, int mask)
1789 return (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT
1790 && INTVAL (op) >= low
1791 && INTVAL (op) <= high
1792 && (INTVAL (op) & mask) == 0);
1796 m16_uimm3_b (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1798 return m16_check_op (op, 0x1, 0x8, 0);
1802 m16_simm4_1 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1804 return m16_check_op (op, - 0x8, 0x7, 0);
1808 m16_nsimm4_1 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1810 return m16_check_op (op, - 0x7, 0x8, 0);
1814 m16_simm5_1 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1816 return m16_check_op (op, - 0x10, 0xf, 0);
1820 m16_nsimm5_1 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1822 return m16_check_op (op, - 0xf, 0x10, 0);
1826 m16_uimm5_4 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1828 return m16_check_op (op, (- 0x10) << 2, 0xf << 2, 3);
1832 m16_nuimm5_4 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1834 return m16_check_op (op, (- 0xf) << 2, 0x10 << 2, 3);
1838 m16_simm8_1 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1840 return m16_check_op (op, - 0x80, 0x7f, 0);
1844 m16_nsimm8_1 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1846 return m16_check_op (op, - 0x7f, 0x80, 0);
1850 m16_uimm8_1 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1852 return m16_check_op (op, 0x0, 0xff, 0);
1856 m16_nuimm8_1 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1858 return m16_check_op (op, - 0xff, 0x0, 0);
1862 m16_uimm8_m1_1 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1864 return m16_check_op (op, - 0x1, 0xfe, 0);
1868 m16_uimm8_4 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1870 return m16_check_op (op, 0x0, 0xff << 2, 3);
1874 m16_nuimm8_4 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1876 return m16_check_op (op, (- 0xff) << 2, 0x0, 3);
1880 m16_simm8_8 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1882 return m16_check_op (op, (- 0x80) << 3, 0x7f << 3, 7);
1886 m16_nsimm8_8 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1888 return m16_check_op (op, (- 0x7f) << 3, 0x80 << 3, 7);
1891 static bool
1892 mips_rtx_costs (rtx x, int code, int outer_code, int *total)
1894 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
1896 switch (code)
1898 case CONST_INT:
1899 if (!TARGET_MIPS16)
1901 /* Always return 0, since we don't have different sized
1902 instructions, hence different costs according to Richard
1903 Kenner */
1904 *total = 0;
1905 return true;
1908 /* A number between 1 and 8 inclusive is efficient for a shift.
1909 Otherwise, we will need an extended instruction. */
1910 if ((outer_code) == ASHIFT || (outer_code) == ASHIFTRT
1911 || (outer_code) == LSHIFTRT)
1913 if (INTVAL (x) >= 1 && INTVAL (x) <= 8)
1914 *total = 0;
1915 else
1916 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
1917 return true;
1920 /* We can use cmpi for an xor with an unsigned 16 bit value. */
1921 if ((outer_code) == XOR
1922 && INTVAL (x) >= 0 && INTVAL (x) < 0x10000)
1924 *total = 0;
1925 return true;
1928 /* We may be able to use slt or sltu for a comparison with a
1929 signed 16 bit value. (The boundary conditions aren't quite
1930 right, but this is just a heuristic anyhow.) */
1931 if (((outer_code) == LT || (outer_code) == LE
1932 || (outer_code) == GE || (outer_code) == GT
1933 || (outer_code) == LTU || (outer_code) == LEU
1934 || (outer_code) == GEU || (outer_code) == GTU)
1935 && INTVAL (x) >= -0x8000 && INTVAL (x) < 0x8000)
1937 *total = 0;
1938 return true;
1941 /* Equality comparisons with 0 are cheap. */
1942 if (((outer_code) == EQ || (outer_code) == NE)
1943 && INTVAL (x) == 0)
1945 *total = 0;
1946 return true;
1949 /* Constants in the range 0...255 can be loaded with an unextended
1950 instruction. They are therefore as cheap as a register move.
1952 Given the choice between "li R1,0...255" and "move R1,R2"
1953 (where R2 is a known constant), it is usually better to use "li",
1954 since we do not want to unnecessarily extend the lifetime of R2. */
1955 if (outer_code == SET
1956 && INTVAL (x) >= 0
1957 && INTVAL (x) < 256)
1959 *total = 0;
1960 return true;
1963 /* Otherwise fall through to the handling below. */
1965 case CONST:
1966 case SYMBOL_REF:
1967 case LABEL_REF:
1968 case CONST_DOUBLE:
1969 if (LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (x))
1971 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
1972 return true;
1974 else
1976 /* The value will need to be fetched from the constant pool. */
1977 *total = CONSTANT_POOL_COST;
1978 return true;
1981 case MEM:
1983 /* If the address is legitimate, return the number of
1984 instructions it needs, otherwise use the default handling. */
1985 int n = mips_address_insns (XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (x));
1986 if (n > 0)
1988 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1 + n);
1989 return true;
1991 return false;
1994 case FFS:
1995 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (6);
1996 return true;
1998 case NOT:
1999 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS ((mode == DImode && !TARGET_64BIT) ? 2 : 1);
2000 return true;
2002 case AND:
2003 case IOR:
2004 case XOR:
2005 if (mode == DImode && !TARGET_64BIT)
2007 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
2008 return true;
2010 return false;
2012 case ASHIFT:
2013 case ASHIFTRT:
2014 case LSHIFTRT:
2015 if (mode == DImode && !TARGET_64BIT)
2017 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS ((GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT)
2018 ? 4 : 12);
2019 return true;
2021 return false;
2023 case ABS:
2024 if (mode == SFmode || mode == DFmode)
2025 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
2026 else
2027 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (4);
2028 return true;
2030 case LO_SUM:
2031 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
2032 return true;
2034 case PLUS:
2035 case MINUS:
2036 if (mode == SFmode || mode == DFmode)
2038 if (TUNE_MIPS3000 || TUNE_MIPS3900)
2039 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
2040 else if (TUNE_MIPS6000)
2041 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (3);
2042 else if (TUNE_SB1)
2043 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (4);
2044 else
2045 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (6);
2046 return true;
2048 if (mode == DImode && !TARGET_64BIT)
2050 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (4);
2051 return true;
2053 return false;
2055 case NEG:
2056 if (mode == DImode && !TARGET_64BIT)
2058 *total = 4;
2059 return true;
2061 return false;
2063 case MULT:
2064 if (mode == SFmode)
2066 if (TUNE_MIPS3000
2067 || TUNE_MIPS3900
2068 || TUNE_MIPS5000
2069 || TUNE_SB1)
2070 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (4);
2071 else if (TUNE_MIPS6000
2072 || TUNE_MIPS5400
2073 || TUNE_MIPS5500)
2074 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (5);
2075 else
2076 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (7);
2077 return true;
2080 if (mode == DFmode)
2082 if (TUNE_SB1)
2083 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (4);
2084 else if (TUNE_MIPS3000
2085 || TUNE_MIPS3900
2086 || TUNE_MIPS5000)
2087 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (5);
2088 else if (TUNE_MIPS6000
2089 || TUNE_MIPS5400
2090 || TUNE_MIPS5500)
2091 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (6);
2092 else
2093 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (8);
2094 return true;
2097 if (TUNE_MIPS3000)
2098 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (12);
2099 else if (TUNE_MIPS3900)
2100 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
2101 else if (TUNE_MIPS4130)
2102 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (mode == DImode ? 6 : 4);
2103 else if (TUNE_MIPS5400 || TUNE_SB1)
2104 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (mode == DImode ? 4 : 3);
2105 else if (TUNE_MIPS5500 || TUNE_MIPS7000)
2106 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (mode == DImode ? 9 : 5);
2107 else if (TUNE_MIPS9000)
2108 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (mode == DImode ? 8 : 3);
2109 else if (TUNE_MIPS6000)
2110 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (17);
2111 else if (TUNE_MIPS5000)
2112 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (5);
2113 else
2114 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (10);
2115 return true;
2117 case DIV:
2118 case MOD:
2119 if (mode == SFmode)
2121 if (TUNE_MIPS3000
2122 || TUNE_MIPS3900)
2123 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (12);
2124 else if (TUNE_MIPS6000)
2125 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (15);
2126 else if (TUNE_SB1)
2127 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (24);
2128 else if (TUNE_MIPS5400 || TUNE_MIPS5500)
2129 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (30);
2130 else
2131 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (23);
2132 return true;
2135 if (mode == DFmode)
2137 if (TUNE_MIPS3000
2138 || TUNE_MIPS3900)
2139 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (19);
2140 else if (TUNE_MIPS5400 || TUNE_MIPS5500)
2141 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (59);
2142 else if (TUNE_MIPS6000)
2143 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (16);
2144 else if (TUNE_SB1)
2145 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (32);
2146 else
2147 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (36);
2148 return true;
2150 /* Fall through. */
2152 case UDIV:
2153 case UMOD:
2154 if (TUNE_MIPS3000
2155 || TUNE_MIPS3900)
2156 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (35);
2157 else if (TUNE_MIPS6000)
2158 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (38);
2159 else if (TUNE_MIPS5000)
2160 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (36);
2161 else if (TUNE_SB1)
2162 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS ((mode == SImode) ? 36 : 68);
2163 else if (TUNE_MIPS5400 || TUNE_MIPS5500)
2164 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS ((mode == SImode) ? 42 : 74);
2165 else
2166 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (69);
2167 return true;
2169 case SIGN_EXTEND:
2170 /* A sign extend from SImode to DImode in 64 bit mode is often
2171 zero instructions, because the result can often be used
2172 directly by another instruction; we'll call it one. */
2173 if (TARGET_64BIT && mode == DImode
2174 && GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SImode)
2175 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
2176 else
2177 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
2178 return true;
2180 case ZERO_EXTEND:
2181 if (TARGET_64BIT && mode == DImode
2182 && GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SImode)
2183 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
2184 else
2185 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
2186 return true;
2188 default:
2189 return false;
2193 /* Provide the costs of an addressing mode that contains ADDR.
2194 If ADDR is not a valid address, its cost is irrelevant. */
2196 static int
2197 mips_address_cost (rtx addr)
2199 return mips_address_insns (addr, SImode);
2202 /* Return one word of double-word value OP, taking into account the fixed
2203 endianness of certain registers. HIGH_P is true to select the high part,
2204 false to select the low part. */
2207 mips_subword (rtx op, int high_p)
2209 unsigned int byte;
2210 enum machine_mode mode;
2212 mode = GET_MODE (op);
2213 if (mode == VOIDmode)
2214 mode = DImode;
2216 if (TARGET_BIG_ENDIAN ? !high_p : high_p)
2217 byte = UNITS_PER_WORD;
2218 else
2219 byte = 0;
2221 if (REG_P (op))
2223 if (FP_REG_P (REGNO (op)))
2224 return gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, high_p ? REGNO (op) + 1 : REGNO (op));
2225 if (REGNO (op) == HI_REGNUM)
2226 return gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, high_p ? HI_REGNUM : LO_REGNUM);
2229 if (MEM_P (op))
2230 return mips_rewrite_small_data (adjust_address (op, word_mode, byte));
2232 return simplify_gen_subreg (word_mode, op, mode, byte);
2236 /* Return true if a 64-bit move from SRC to DEST should be split into two. */
2238 bool
2239 mips_split_64bit_move_p (rtx dest, rtx src)
2241 if (TARGET_64BIT)
2242 return false;
2244 /* FP->FP moves can be done in a single instruction. */
2245 if (FP_REG_RTX_P (src) && FP_REG_RTX_P (dest))
2246 return false;
2248 /* Check for floating-point loads and stores. They can be done using
2249 ldc1 and sdc1 on MIPS II and above. */
2250 if (mips_isa > 1)
2252 if (FP_REG_RTX_P (dest) && MEM_P (src))
2253 return false;
2254 if (FP_REG_RTX_P (src) && MEM_P (dest))
2255 return false;
2257 return true;
2261 /* Split a 64-bit move from SRC to DEST assuming that
2262 mips_split_64bit_move_p holds.
2264 Moves into and out of FPRs cause some difficulty here. Such moves
2265 will always be DFmode, since paired FPRs are not allowed to store
2266 DImode values. The most natural representation would be two separate
2267 32-bit moves, such as:
2269 (set (reg:SI $f0) (mem:SI ...))
2270 (set (reg:SI $f1) (mem:SI ...))
2272 However, the second insn is invalid because odd-numbered FPRs are
2273 not allowed to store independent values. Use the patterns load_df_low,
2274 load_df_high and store_df_high instead. */
2276 void
2277 mips_split_64bit_move (rtx dest, rtx src)
2279 if (FP_REG_RTX_P (dest))
2281 /* Loading an FPR from memory or from GPRs. */
2282 emit_insn (gen_load_df_low (copy_rtx (dest), mips_subword (src, 0)));
2283 emit_insn (gen_load_df_high (dest, mips_subword (src, 1),
2284 copy_rtx (dest)));
2286 else if (FP_REG_RTX_P (src))
2288 /* Storing an FPR into memory or GPRs. */
2289 emit_move_insn (mips_subword (dest, 0), mips_subword (src, 0));
2290 emit_insn (gen_store_df_high (mips_subword (dest, 1), src));
2292 else
2294 /* The operation can be split into two normal moves. Decide in
2295 which order to do them. */
2296 rtx low_dest;
2298 low_dest = mips_subword (dest, 0);
2299 if (REG_P (low_dest)
2300 && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (low_dest, src))
2302 emit_move_insn (mips_subword (dest, 1), mips_subword (src, 1));
2303 emit_move_insn (low_dest, mips_subword (src, 0));
2305 else
2307 emit_move_insn (low_dest, mips_subword (src, 0));
2308 emit_move_insn (mips_subword (dest, 1), mips_subword (src, 1));
2313 /* Return the appropriate instructions to move SRC into DEST. Assume
2314 that SRC is operand 1 and DEST is operand 0. */
2316 const char *
2317 mips_output_move (rtx dest, rtx src)
2319 enum rtx_code dest_code, src_code;
2320 bool dbl_p;
2322 dest_code = GET_CODE (dest);
2323 src_code = GET_CODE (src);
2324 dbl_p = (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest)) == 8);
2326 if (dbl_p && mips_split_64bit_move_p (dest, src))
2327 return "#";
2329 if ((src_code == REG && GP_REG_P (REGNO (src)))
2330 || (!TARGET_MIPS16 && src == CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (dest))))
2332 if (dest_code == REG)
2334 if (GP_REG_P (REGNO (dest)))
2335 return "move\t%0,%z1";
2337 if (MD_REG_P (REGNO (dest)))
2338 return "mt%0\t%z1";
2340 if (FP_REG_P (REGNO (dest)))
2341 return (dbl_p ? "dmtc1\t%z1,%0" : "mtc1\t%z1,%0");
2343 if (ALL_COP_REG_P (REGNO (dest)))
2345 static char retval[] = "dmtc_\t%z1,%0";
2347 retval[4] = COPNUM_AS_CHAR_FROM_REGNUM (REGNO (dest));
2348 return (dbl_p ? retval : retval + 1);
2351 if (dest_code == MEM)
2352 return (dbl_p ? "sd\t%z1,%0" : "sw\t%z1,%0");
2354 if (dest_code == REG && GP_REG_P (REGNO (dest)))
2356 if (src_code == REG)
2358 if (ST_REG_P (REGNO (src)) && ISA_HAS_8CC)
2359 return "lui\t%0,0x3f80\n\tmovf\t%0,%.,%1";
2361 if (FP_REG_P (REGNO (src)))
2362 return (dbl_p ? "dmfc1\t%0,%1" : "mfc1\t%0,%1");
2364 if (ALL_COP_REG_P (REGNO (src)))
2366 static char retval[] = "dmfc_\t%0,%1";
2368 retval[4] = COPNUM_AS_CHAR_FROM_REGNUM (REGNO (src));
2369 return (dbl_p ? retval : retval + 1);
2373 if (src_code == MEM)
2374 return (dbl_p ? "ld\t%0,%1" : "lw\t%0,%1");
2376 if (src_code == CONST_INT)
2378 /* Don't use the X format, because that will give out of
2379 range numbers for 64 bit hosts and 32 bit targets. */
2380 if (!TARGET_MIPS16)
2381 return "li\t%0,%1\t\t\t# %X1";
2383 if (INTVAL (src) >= 0 && INTVAL (src) <= 0xffff)
2384 return "li\t%0,%1";
2386 if (INTVAL (src) < 0 && INTVAL (src) >= -0xffff)
2387 return "#";
2390 if (src_code == HIGH)
2391 return "lui\t%0,%h1";
2393 if (CONST_GP_P (src))
2394 return "move\t%0,%1";
2396 if (symbolic_operand (src, VOIDmode))
2397 return (dbl_p ? "dla\t%0,%1" : "la\t%0,%1");
2399 if (src_code == REG && FP_REG_P (REGNO (src)))
2401 if (dest_code == REG && FP_REG_P (REGNO (dest)))
2403 if (GET_MODE (dest) == V2SFmode)
2404 return "mov.ps\t%0,%1";
2405 else
2406 return (dbl_p ? "mov.d\t%0,%1" : "mov.s\t%0,%1");
2409 if (dest_code == MEM)
2410 return (dbl_p ? "sdc1\t%1,%0" : "swc1\t%1,%0");
2412 if (dest_code == REG && FP_REG_P (REGNO (dest)))
2414 if (src_code == MEM)
2415 return (dbl_p ? "ldc1\t%0,%1" : "lwc1\t%0,%1");
2417 if (dest_code == REG && ALL_COP_REG_P (REGNO (dest)) && src_code == MEM)
2419 static char retval[] = "l_c_\t%0,%1";
2421 retval[1] = (dbl_p ? 'd' : 'w');
2422 retval[3] = COPNUM_AS_CHAR_FROM_REGNUM (REGNO (dest));
2423 return retval;
2425 if (dest_code == MEM && src_code == REG && ALL_COP_REG_P (REGNO (src)))
2427 static char retval[] = "s_c_\t%1,%0";
2429 retval[1] = (dbl_p ? 'd' : 'w');
2430 retval[3] = COPNUM_AS_CHAR_FROM_REGNUM (REGNO (src));
2431 return retval;
2433 gcc_unreachable ();
2436 /* Restore $gp from its save slot. Valid only when using o32 or
2437 o64 abicalls. */
2439 void
2440 mips_restore_gp (void)
2442 rtx address, slot;
2444 gcc_assert (TARGET_ABICALLS && TARGET_OLDABI);
2446 address = mips_add_offset (pic_offset_table_rtx,
2447 frame_pointer_needed
2448 ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
2449 : stack_pointer_rtx,
2450 current_function_outgoing_args_size);
2451 slot = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, address);
2453 emit_move_insn (pic_offset_table_rtx, slot);
2454 if (!TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS)
2455 emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
2458 /* Emit an instruction of the form (set TARGET (CODE OP0 OP1)). */
2460 static void
2461 mips_emit_binary (enum rtx_code code, rtx target, rtx op0, rtx op1)
2463 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target,
2464 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, GET_MODE (target), op0, op1)));
2467 /* Return true if CMP1 is a suitable second operand for relational
2468 operator CODE. See also the *sCC patterns in mips.md. */
2470 static bool
2471 mips_relational_operand_ok_p (enum rtx_code code, rtx cmp1)
2473 switch (code)
2475 case GT:
2476 case GTU:
2477 return reg_or_0_operand (cmp1, VOIDmode);
2479 case GE:
2480 case GEU:
2481 return !TARGET_MIPS16 && cmp1 == const1_rtx;
2483 case LT:
2484 case LTU:
2485 return arith_operand (cmp1, VOIDmode);
2487 case LE:
2488 return sle_operand (cmp1, VOIDmode);
2490 case LEU:
2491 return sleu_operand (cmp1, VOIDmode);
2493 default:
2494 gcc_unreachable ();
2498 /* Compare CMP0 and CMP1 using relational operator CODE and store the
2499 result in TARGET. CMP0 and TARGET are register_operands that have
2500 the same integer mode. If INVERT_PTR is nonnull, it's OK to set
2501 TARGET to the inverse of the result and flip *INVERT_PTR instead. */
2503 static void
2504 mips_emit_int_relational (enum rtx_code code, bool *invert_ptr,
2505 rtx target, rtx cmp0, rtx cmp1)
2507 /* First see if there is a MIPS instruction that can do this operation
2508 with CMP1 in its current form. If not, try doing the same for the
2509 inverse operation. If that also fails, force CMP1 into a register
2510 and try again. */
2511 if (mips_relational_operand_ok_p (code, cmp1))
2512 mips_emit_binary (code, target, cmp0, cmp1);
2513 else
2515 enum rtx_code inv_code = reverse_condition (code);
2516 if (!mips_relational_operand_ok_p (inv_code, cmp1))
2518 cmp1 = force_reg (GET_MODE (cmp0), cmp1);
2519 mips_emit_int_relational (code, invert_ptr, target, cmp0, cmp1);
2521 else if (invert_ptr == 0)
2523 rtx inv_target = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (target));
2524 mips_emit_binary (inv_code, inv_target, cmp0, cmp1);
2525 mips_emit_binary (XOR, target, inv_target, const1_rtx);
2527 else
2529 *invert_ptr = !*invert_ptr;
2530 mips_emit_binary (inv_code, target, cmp0, cmp1);
2535 /* Return a register that is zero iff CMP0 and CMP1 are equal.
2536 The register will have the same mode as CMP0. */
2538 static rtx
2539 mips_zero_if_equal (rtx cmp0, rtx cmp1)
2541 if (cmp1 == const0_rtx)
2542 return cmp0;
2544 if (uns_arith_operand (cmp1, VOIDmode))
2545 return expand_binop (GET_MODE (cmp0), xor_optab,
2546 cmp0, cmp1, 0, 0, OPTAB_DIRECT);
2548 return expand_binop (GET_MODE (cmp0), sub_optab,
2549 cmp0, cmp1, 0, 0, OPTAB_DIRECT);
2552 /* Convert a comparison into something that can be used in a branch or
2553 conditional move. cmp_operands[0] and cmp_operands[1] are the values
2554 being compared and *CODE is the code used to compare them.
2556 Update *CODE, *OP0 and *OP1 so that they describe the final comparison.
2557 If NEED_EQ_NE_P, then only EQ/NE comparisons against zero are possible,
2558 otherwise any standard branch condition can be used. The standard branch
2559 conditions are:
2561 - EQ/NE between two registers.
2562 - any comparison between a register and zero. */
2564 static void
2565 mips_emit_compare (enum rtx_code *code, rtx *op0, rtx *op1, bool need_eq_ne_p)
2567 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (cmp_operands[0])) == MODE_INT)
2569 if (!need_eq_ne_p && cmp_operands[1] == const0_rtx)
2571 *op0 = cmp_operands[0];
2572 *op1 = cmp_operands[1];
2574 else if (*code == EQ || *code == NE)
2576 if (need_eq_ne_p)
2578 *op0 = mips_zero_if_equal (cmp_operands[0], cmp_operands[1]);
2579 *op1 = const0_rtx;
2581 else
2583 *op0 = cmp_operands[0];
2584 *op1 = force_reg (GET_MODE (*op0), cmp_operands[1]);
2587 else
2589 /* The comparison needs a separate scc instruction. Store the
2590 result of the scc in *OP0 and compare it against zero. */
2591 bool invert = false;
2592 *op0 = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (cmp_operands[0]));
2593 *op1 = const0_rtx;
2594 mips_emit_int_relational (*code, &invert, *op0,
2595 cmp_operands[0], cmp_operands[1]);
2596 *code = (invert ? EQ : NE);
2599 else
2601 enum rtx_code cmp_code;
2603 /* Floating-point tests use a separate c.cond.fmt comparison to
2604 set a condition code register. The branch or conditional move
2605 will then compare that register against zero.
2607 Set CMP_CODE to the code of the comparison instruction and
2608 *CODE to the code that the branch or move should use. */
2609 switch (*code)
2611 case NE:
2612 case UNGE:
2613 case UNGT:
2614 case LTGT:
2615 case ORDERED:
2616 cmp_code = reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (*code);
2617 *code = EQ;
2618 break;
2620 default:
2621 cmp_code = *code;
2622 *code = NE;
2623 break;
2625 *op0 = (ISA_HAS_8CC
2626 ? gen_reg_rtx (CCmode)
2627 : gen_rtx_REG (CCmode, FPSW_REGNUM));
2628 *op1 = const0_rtx;
2629 mips_emit_binary (cmp_code, *op0, cmp_operands[0], cmp_operands[1]);
2633 /* Try comparing cmp_operands[0] and cmp_operands[1] using rtl code CODE.
2634 Store the result in TARGET and return true if successful.
2636 On 64-bit targets, TARGET may be wider than cmp_operands[0]. */
2638 bool
2639 mips_emit_scc (enum rtx_code code, rtx target)
2641 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (cmp_operands[0])) != MODE_INT)
2642 return false;
2644 target = gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (cmp_operands[0]), target);
2645 if (code == EQ || code == NE)
2647 rtx zie = mips_zero_if_equal (cmp_operands[0], cmp_operands[1]);
2648 mips_emit_binary (code, target, zie, const0_rtx);
2650 else
2651 mips_emit_int_relational (code, 0, target,
2652 cmp_operands[0], cmp_operands[1]);
2653 return true;
2656 /* Emit the common code for doing conditional branches.
2657 operand[0] is the label to jump to.
2658 The comparison operands are saved away by cmp{si,di,sf,df}. */
2660 void
2661 gen_conditional_branch (rtx *operands, enum rtx_code code)
2663 rtx op0, op1, target;
2665 mips_emit_compare (&code, &op0, &op1, TARGET_MIPS16);
2666 target = gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (VOIDmode,
2667 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, GET_MODE (op0),
2668 op0, op1),
2669 gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (VOIDmode, operands[0]),
2670 pc_rtx);
2671 emit_jump_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, pc_rtx, target));
2674 /* Emit the common code for conditional moves. OPERANDS is the array
2675 of operands passed to the conditional move define_expand. */
2677 void
2678 gen_conditional_move (rtx *operands)
2680 enum rtx_code code;
2681 rtx op0, op1;
2683 code = GET_CODE (operands[1]);
2684 mips_emit_compare (&code, &op0, &op1, true);
2685 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, operands[0],
2686 gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (GET_MODE (operands[0]),
2687 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code,
2688 GET_MODE (op0),
2689 op0, op1),
2690 operands[2], operands[3])));
2693 /* Emit a conditional trap. OPERANDS is the array of operands passed to
2694 the conditional_trap expander. */
2696 void
2697 mips_gen_conditional_trap (rtx *operands)
2699 rtx op0, op1;
2700 enum rtx_code cmp_code = GET_CODE (operands[0]);
2701 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (cmp_operands[0]);
2703 /* MIPS conditional trap machine instructions don't have GT or LE
2704 flavors, so we must invert the comparison and convert to LT and
2705 GE, respectively. */
2706 switch (cmp_code)
2708 case GT: cmp_code = LT; break;
2709 case LE: cmp_code = GE; break;
2710 case GTU: cmp_code = LTU; break;
2711 case LEU: cmp_code = GEU; break;
2712 default: break;
2714 if (cmp_code == GET_CODE (operands[0]))
2716 op0 = cmp_operands[0];
2717 op1 = cmp_operands[1];
2719 else
2721 op0 = cmp_operands[1];
2722 op1 = cmp_operands[0];
2724 op0 = force_reg (mode, op0);
2725 if (!arith_operand (op1, mode))
2726 op1 = force_reg (mode, op1);
2728 emit_insn (gen_rtx_TRAP_IF (VOIDmode,
2729 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (cmp_code, mode, op0, op1),
2730 operands[1]));
2733 /* Load function address ADDR into register DEST. SIBCALL_P is true
2734 if the address is needed for a sibling call. */
2736 static void
2737 mips_load_call_address (rtx dest, rtx addr, int sibcall_p)
2739 /* If we're generating PIC, and this call is to a global function,
2740 try to allow its address to be resolved lazily. This isn't
2741 possible for NewABI sibcalls since the value of $gp on entry
2742 to the stub would be our caller's gp, not ours. */
2743 if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS
2744 && !(sibcall_p && TARGET_NEWABI)
2745 && global_got_operand (addr, VOIDmode))
2747 rtx high, lo_sum_symbol;
2749 high = mips_unspec_offset_high (dest, pic_offset_table_rtx,
2750 addr, SYMBOL_GOTOFF_CALL);
2751 lo_sum_symbol = mips_unspec_address (addr, SYMBOL_GOTOFF_CALL);
2752 if (Pmode == SImode)
2753 emit_insn (gen_load_callsi (dest, high, lo_sum_symbol));
2754 else
2755 emit_insn (gen_load_calldi (dest, high, lo_sum_symbol));
2757 else
2758 emit_move_insn (dest, addr);
2762 /* Expand a call or call_value instruction. RESULT is where the
2763 result will go (null for calls), ADDR is the address of the
2764 function, ARGS_SIZE is the size of the arguments and AUX is
2765 the value passed to us by mips_function_arg. SIBCALL_P is true
2766 if we are expanding a sibling call, false if we're expanding
2767 a normal call. */
2769 void
2770 mips_expand_call (rtx result, rtx addr, rtx args_size, rtx aux, int sibcall_p)
2772 rtx orig_addr, pattern, insn;
2774 orig_addr = addr;
2775 if (!call_insn_operand (addr, VOIDmode))
2777 addr = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
2778 mips_load_call_address (addr, orig_addr, sibcall_p);
2781 if (TARGET_MIPS16
2782 && mips16_hard_float
2783 && build_mips16_call_stub (result, addr, args_size,
2784 aux == 0 ? 0 : (int) GET_MODE (aux)))
2785 return;
2787 if (result == 0)
2788 pattern = (sibcall_p
2789 ? gen_sibcall_internal (addr, args_size)
2790 : gen_call_internal (addr, args_size));
2791 else if (GET_CODE (result) == PARALLEL && XVECLEN (result, 0) == 2)
2793 rtx reg1, reg2;
2795 reg1 = XEXP (XVECEXP (result, 0, 0), 0);
2796 reg2 = XEXP (XVECEXP (result, 0, 1), 0);
2797 pattern =
2798 (sibcall_p
2799 ? gen_sibcall_value_multiple_internal (reg1, addr, args_size, reg2)
2800 : gen_call_value_multiple_internal (reg1, addr, args_size, reg2));
2802 else
2803 pattern = (sibcall_p
2804 ? gen_sibcall_value_internal (result, addr, args_size)
2805 : gen_call_value_internal (result, addr, args_size));
2807 insn = emit_call_insn (pattern);
2809 /* Lazy-binding stubs require $gp to be valid on entry. */
2810 if (global_got_operand (orig_addr, VOIDmode))
2811 use_reg (&CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn), pic_offset_table_rtx);
2815 /* We can handle any sibcall when TARGET_SIBCALLS is true. */
2817 static bool
2818 mips_function_ok_for_sibcall (tree decl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2819 tree exp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2821 return TARGET_SIBCALLS;
2824 /* Emit code to move general operand SRC into condition-code
2825 register DEST. SCRATCH is a scratch TFmode float register.
2826 The sequence is:
2828 FP1 = SRC
2829 FP2 = 0.0f
2830 DEST = FP2 < FP1
2832 where FP1 and FP2 are single-precision float registers
2833 taken from SCRATCH. */
2835 void
2836 mips_emit_fcc_reload (rtx dest, rtx src, rtx scratch)
2838 rtx fp1, fp2;
2840 /* Change the source to SFmode. */
2841 if (MEM_P (src))
2842 src = adjust_address (src, SFmode, 0);
2843 else if (REG_P (src) || GET_CODE (src) == SUBREG)
2844 src = gen_rtx_REG (SFmode, true_regnum (src));
2846 fp1 = gen_rtx_REG (SFmode, REGNO (scratch));
2847 fp2 = gen_rtx_REG (SFmode, REGNO (scratch) + FP_INC);
2849 emit_move_insn (copy_rtx (fp1), src);
2850 emit_move_insn (copy_rtx (fp2), CONST0_RTX (SFmode));
2851 emit_insn (gen_slt_sf (dest, fp2, fp1));
2854 /* Emit code to change the current function's return address to
2855 ADDRESS. SCRATCH is available as a scratch register, if needed.
2856 ADDRESS and SCRATCH are both word-mode GPRs. */
2858 void
2859 mips_set_return_address (rtx address, rtx scratch)
2861 rtx slot_address;
2863 compute_frame_size (get_frame_size ());
2864 gcc_assert ((cfun->machine->frame.mask >> 31) & 1);
2865 slot_address = mips_add_offset (scratch, stack_pointer_rtx,
2866 cfun->machine->frame.gp_sp_offset);
2868 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (GET_MODE (address), slot_address), address);
2871 /* Emit straight-line code to move LENGTH bytes from SRC to DEST.
2872 Assume that the areas do not overlap. */
2874 static void
2875 mips_block_move_straight (rtx dest, rtx src, HOST_WIDE_INT length)
2877 HOST_WIDE_INT offset, delta;
2878 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bits;
2879 int i;
2880 enum machine_mode mode;
2881 rtx *regs;
2883 /* Work out how many bits to move at a time. If both operands have
2884 half-word alignment, it is usually better to move in half words.
2885 For instance, lh/lh/sh/sh is usually better than lwl/lwr/swl/swr
2886 and lw/lw/sw/sw is usually better than ldl/ldr/sdl/sdr.
2887 Otherwise move word-sized chunks. */
2888 if (MEM_ALIGN (src) == BITS_PER_WORD / 2
2889 && MEM_ALIGN (dest) == BITS_PER_WORD / 2)
2890 bits = BITS_PER_WORD / 2;
2891 else
2892 bits = BITS_PER_WORD;
2894 mode = mode_for_size (bits, MODE_INT, 0);
2895 delta = bits / BITS_PER_UNIT;
2897 /* Allocate a buffer for the temporary registers. */
2898 regs = alloca (sizeof (rtx) * length / delta);
2900 /* Load as many BITS-sized chunks as possible. Use a normal load if
2901 the source has enough alignment, otherwise use left/right pairs. */
2902 for (offset = 0, i = 0; offset + delta <= length; offset += delta, i++)
2904 regs[i] = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
2905 if (MEM_ALIGN (src) >= bits)
2906 emit_move_insn (regs[i], adjust_address (src, mode, offset));
2907 else
2909 rtx part = adjust_address (src, BLKmode, offset);
2910 if (!mips_expand_unaligned_load (regs[i], part, bits, 0))
2911 gcc_unreachable ();
2915 /* Copy the chunks to the destination. */
2916 for (offset = 0, i = 0; offset + delta <= length; offset += delta, i++)
2917 if (MEM_ALIGN (dest) >= bits)
2918 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (dest, mode, offset), regs[i]);
2919 else
2921 rtx part = adjust_address (dest, BLKmode, offset);
2922 if (!mips_expand_unaligned_store (part, regs[i], bits, 0))
2923 gcc_unreachable ();
2926 /* Mop up any left-over bytes. */
2927 if (offset < length)
2929 src = adjust_address (src, BLKmode, offset);
2930 dest = adjust_address (dest, BLKmode, offset);
2931 move_by_pieces (dest, src, length - offset,
2932 MIN (MEM_ALIGN (src), MEM_ALIGN (dest)), 0);
2936 #define MAX_MOVE_REGS 4
2937 #define MAX_MOVE_BYTES (MAX_MOVE_REGS * UNITS_PER_WORD)
2940 /* Helper function for doing a loop-based block operation on memory
2941 reference MEM. Each iteration of the loop will operate on LENGTH
2942 bytes of MEM.
2944 Create a new base register for use within the loop and point it to
2945 the start of MEM. Create a new memory reference that uses this
2946 register. Store them in *LOOP_REG and *LOOP_MEM respectively. */
2948 static void
2949 mips_adjust_block_mem (rtx mem, HOST_WIDE_INT length,
2950 rtx *loop_reg, rtx *loop_mem)
2952 *loop_reg = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (mem, 0));
2954 /* Although the new mem does not refer to a known location,
2955 it does keep up to LENGTH bytes of alignment. */
2956 *loop_mem = change_address (mem, BLKmode, *loop_reg);
2957 set_mem_align (*loop_mem, MIN (MEM_ALIGN (mem), length * BITS_PER_UNIT));
2961 /* Move LENGTH bytes from SRC to DEST using a loop that moves MAX_MOVE_BYTES
2962 per iteration. LENGTH must be at least MAX_MOVE_BYTES. Assume that the
2963 memory regions do not overlap. */
2965 static void
2966 mips_block_move_loop (rtx dest, rtx src, HOST_WIDE_INT length)
2968 rtx label, src_reg, dest_reg, final_src;
2969 HOST_WIDE_INT leftover;
2971 leftover = length % MAX_MOVE_BYTES;
2972 length -= leftover;
2974 /* Create registers and memory references for use within the loop. */
2975 mips_adjust_block_mem (src, MAX_MOVE_BYTES, &src_reg, &src);
2976 mips_adjust_block_mem (dest, MAX_MOVE_BYTES, &dest_reg, &dest);
2978 /* Calculate the value that SRC_REG should have after the last iteration
2979 of the loop. */
2980 final_src = expand_simple_binop (Pmode, PLUS, src_reg, GEN_INT (length),
2981 0, 0, OPTAB_WIDEN);
2983 /* Emit the start of the loop. */
2984 label = gen_label_rtx ();
2985 emit_label (label);
2987 /* Emit the loop body. */
2988 mips_block_move_straight (dest, src, MAX_MOVE_BYTES);
2990 /* Move on to the next block. */
2991 emit_move_insn (src_reg, plus_constant (src_reg, MAX_MOVE_BYTES));
2992 emit_move_insn (dest_reg, plus_constant (dest_reg, MAX_MOVE_BYTES));
2994 /* Emit the loop condition. */
2995 if (Pmode == DImode)
2996 emit_insn (gen_cmpdi (src_reg, final_src));
2997 else
2998 emit_insn (gen_cmpsi (src_reg, final_src));
2999 emit_jump_insn (gen_bne (label));
3001 /* Mop up any left-over bytes. */
3002 if (leftover)
3003 mips_block_move_straight (dest, src, leftover);
3006 /* Expand a movmemsi instruction. */
3008 bool
3009 mips_expand_block_move (rtx dest, rtx src, rtx length)
3011 if (GET_CODE (length) == CONST_INT)
3013 if (INTVAL (length) <= 2 * MAX_MOVE_BYTES)
3015 mips_block_move_straight (dest, src, INTVAL (length));
3016 return true;
3018 else if (optimize)
3020 mips_block_move_loop (dest, src, INTVAL (length));
3021 return true;
3024 return false;
3027 /* Argument support functions. */
3029 /* Initialize CUMULATIVE_ARGS for a function. */
3031 void
3032 init_cumulative_args (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum, tree fntype,
3033 rtx libname ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3035 static CUMULATIVE_ARGS zero_cum;
3036 tree param, next_param;
3038 *cum = zero_cum;
3039 cum->prototype = (fntype && TYPE_ARG_TYPES (fntype));
3041 /* Determine if this function has variable arguments. This is
3042 indicated by the last argument being 'void_type_mode' if there
3043 are no variable arguments. The standard MIPS calling sequence
3044 passes all arguments in the general purpose registers in this case. */
3046 for (param = fntype ? TYPE_ARG_TYPES (fntype) : 0;
3047 param != 0; param = next_param)
3049 next_param = TREE_CHAIN (param);
3050 if (next_param == 0 && TREE_VALUE (param) != void_type_node)
3051 cum->gp_reg_found = 1;
3056 /* Fill INFO with information about a single argument. CUM is the
3057 cumulative state for earlier arguments. MODE is the mode of this
3058 argument and TYPE is its type (if known). NAMED is true if this
3059 is a named (fixed) argument rather than a variable one. */
3061 static void
3062 mips_arg_info (const CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum, enum machine_mode mode,
3063 tree type, int named, struct mips_arg_info *info)
3065 bool doubleword_aligned_p;
3066 unsigned int num_bytes, num_words, max_regs;
3068 /* Work out the size of the argument. */
3069 num_bytes = type ? int_size_in_bytes (type) : GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
3070 num_words = (num_bytes + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
3072 /* Decide whether it should go in a floating-point register, assuming
3073 one is free. Later code checks for availability.
3075 The checks against UNITS_PER_FPVALUE handle the soft-float and
3076 single-float cases. */
3077 switch (mips_abi)
3079 case ABI_EABI:
3080 /* The EABI conventions have traditionally been defined in terms
3081 of TYPE_MODE, regardless of the actual type. */
3082 info->fpr_p = ((GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT
3083 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT)
3084 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= UNITS_PER_FPVALUE);
3085 break;
3087 case ABI_32:
3088 case ABI_O64:
3089 /* Only leading floating-point scalars are passed in
3090 floating-point registers. We also handle vector floats the same
3091 say, which is OK because they are not covered by the standard ABI. */
3092 info->fpr_p = (!cum->gp_reg_found
3093 && cum->arg_number < 2
3094 && (type == 0 || SCALAR_FLOAT_TYPE_P (type)
3095 || VECTOR_FLOAT_TYPE_P (type))
3096 && (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT
3097 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT)
3098 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= UNITS_PER_FPVALUE);
3099 break;
3101 case ABI_N32:
3102 case ABI_64:
3103 /* Scalar and complex floating-point types are passed in
3104 floating-point registers. */
3105 info->fpr_p = (named
3106 && (type == 0 || FLOAT_TYPE_P (type))
3107 && (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT
3108 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT
3109 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT)
3110 && GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode) <= UNITS_PER_FPVALUE);
3112 /* ??? According to the ABI documentation, the real and imaginary
3113 parts of complex floats should be passed in individual registers.
3114 The real and imaginary parts of stack arguments are supposed
3115 to be contiguous and there should be an extra word of padding
3116 at the end.
3118 This has two problems. First, it makes it impossible to use a
3119 single "void *" va_list type, since register and stack arguments
3120 are passed differently. (At the time of writing, MIPSpro cannot
3121 handle complex float varargs correctly.) Second, it's unclear
3122 what should happen when there is only one register free.
3124 For now, we assume that named complex floats should go into FPRs
3125 if there are two FPRs free, otherwise they should be passed in the
3126 same way as a struct containing two floats. */
3127 if (info->fpr_p
3128 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT
3129 && GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode) < UNITS_PER_FPVALUE)
3131 if (cum->num_gprs >= MAX_ARGS_IN_REGISTERS - 1)
3132 info->fpr_p = false;
3133 else
3134 num_words = 2;
3136 break;
3138 default:
3139 gcc_unreachable ();
3142 /* See whether the argument has doubleword alignment. */
3143 doubleword_aligned_p = FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (mode, type) > BITS_PER_WORD;
3145 /* Set REG_OFFSET to the register count we're interested in.
3146 The EABI allocates the floating-point registers separately,
3147 but the other ABIs allocate them like integer registers. */
3148 info->reg_offset = (mips_abi == ABI_EABI && info->fpr_p
3149 ? cum->num_fprs
3150 : cum->num_gprs);
3152 /* Advance to an even register if the argument is doubleword-aligned. */
3153 if (doubleword_aligned_p)
3154 info->reg_offset += info->reg_offset & 1;
3156 /* Work out the offset of a stack argument. */
3157 info->stack_offset = cum->stack_words;
3158 if (doubleword_aligned_p)
3159 info->stack_offset += info->stack_offset & 1;
3161 max_regs = MAX_ARGS_IN_REGISTERS - info->reg_offset;
3163 /* Partition the argument between registers and stack. */
3164 info->reg_words = MIN (num_words, max_regs);
3165 info->stack_words = num_words - info->reg_words;
3169 /* Implement FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE. */
3171 void
3172 function_arg_advance (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum, enum machine_mode mode,
3173 tree type, int named)
3175 struct mips_arg_info info;
3177 mips_arg_info (cum, mode, type, named, &info);
3179 if (!info.fpr_p)
3180 cum->gp_reg_found = true;
3182 /* See the comment above the cumulative args structure in mips.h
3183 for an explanation of what this code does. It assumes the O32
3184 ABI, which passes at most 2 arguments in float registers. */
3185 if (cum->arg_number < 2 && info.fpr_p)
3186 cum->fp_code += (mode == SFmode ? 1 : 2) << ((cum->arg_number - 1) * 2);
3188 if (mips_abi != ABI_EABI || !info.fpr_p)
3189 cum->num_gprs = info.reg_offset + info.reg_words;
3190 else if (info.reg_words > 0)
3191 cum->num_fprs += FP_INC;
3193 if (info.stack_words > 0)
3194 cum->stack_words = info.stack_offset + info.stack_words;
3196 cum->arg_number++;
3199 /* Implement FUNCTION_ARG. */
3201 struct rtx_def *
3202 function_arg (const CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum, enum machine_mode mode,
3203 tree type, int named)
3205 struct mips_arg_info info;
3207 /* We will be called with a mode of VOIDmode after the last argument
3208 has been seen. Whatever we return will be passed to the call
3209 insn. If we need a mips16 fp_code, return a REG with the code
3210 stored as the mode. */
3211 if (mode == VOIDmode)
3213 if (TARGET_MIPS16 && cum->fp_code != 0)
3214 return gen_rtx_REG ((enum machine_mode) cum->fp_code, 0);
3216 else
3217 return 0;
3220 mips_arg_info (cum, mode, type, named, &info);
3222 /* Return straight away if the whole argument is passed on the stack. */
3223 if (info.reg_offset == MAX_ARGS_IN_REGISTERS)
3224 return 0;
3226 if (type != 0
3227 && TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
3228 && TARGET_NEWABI
3229 && TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type)
3230 && host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type), 1)
3231 && named)
3233 /* The Irix 6 n32/n64 ABIs say that if any 64 bit chunk of the
3234 structure contains a double in its entirety, then that 64 bit
3235 chunk is passed in a floating point register. */
3236 tree field;
3238 /* First check to see if there is any such field. */
3239 for (field = TYPE_FIELDS (type); field; field = TREE_CHAIN (field))
3240 if (TREE_CODE (field) == FIELD_DECL
3241 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (field)) == REAL_TYPE
3242 && TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (field)) == BITS_PER_WORD
3243 && host_integerp (bit_position (field), 0)
3244 && int_bit_position (field) % BITS_PER_WORD == 0)
3245 break;
3247 if (field != 0)
3249 /* Now handle the special case by returning a PARALLEL
3250 indicating where each 64 bit chunk goes. INFO.REG_WORDS
3251 chunks are passed in registers. */
3252 unsigned int i;
3253 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos;
3254 rtx ret;
3256 /* assign_parms checks the mode of ENTRY_PARM, so we must
3257 use the actual mode here. */
3258 ret = gen_rtx_PARALLEL (mode, rtvec_alloc (info.reg_words));
3260 bitpos = 0;
3261 field = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
3262 for (i = 0; i < info.reg_words; i++)
3264 rtx reg;
3266 for (; field; field = TREE_CHAIN (field))
3267 if (TREE_CODE (field) == FIELD_DECL
3268 && int_bit_position (field) >= bitpos)
3269 break;
3271 if (field
3272 && int_bit_position (field) == bitpos
3273 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (field)) == REAL_TYPE
3274 && !TARGET_SOFT_FLOAT
3275 && TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (field)) == BITS_PER_WORD)
3276 reg = gen_rtx_REG (DFmode, FP_ARG_FIRST + info.reg_offset + i);
3277 else
3278 reg = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, GP_ARG_FIRST + info.reg_offset + i);
3280 XVECEXP (ret, 0, i)
3281 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, reg,
3282 GEN_INT (bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT));
3284 bitpos += BITS_PER_WORD;
3286 return ret;
3290 /* Handle the n32/n64 conventions for passing complex floating-point
3291 arguments in FPR pairs. The real part goes in the lower register
3292 and the imaginary part goes in the upper register. */
3293 if (TARGET_NEWABI
3294 && info.fpr_p
3295 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT)
3297 rtx real, imag;
3298 enum machine_mode inner;
3299 int reg;
3301 inner = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
3302 reg = FP_ARG_FIRST + info.reg_offset;
3303 real = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode,
3304 gen_rtx_REG (inner, reg),
3305 const0_rtx);
3306 imag = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode,
3307 gen_rtx_REG (inner, reg + info.reg_words / 2),
3308 GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (inner)));
3309 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (mode, gen_rtvec (2, real, imag));
3312 if (!info.fpr_p)
3313 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, GP_ARG_FIRST + info.reg_offset);
3314 else if (info.reg_offset == 1)
3315 /* This code handles the special o32 case in which the second word
3316 of the argument structure is passed in floating-point registers. */
3317 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, FP_ARG_FIRST + FP_INC);
3318 else
3319 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, FP_ARG_FIRST + info.reg_offset);
3323 /* Implement TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES. */
3325 static int
3326 mips_arg_partial_bytes (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum,
3327 enum machine_mode mode, tree type, bool named)
3329 struct mips_arg_info info;
3331 mips_arg_info (cum, mode, type, named, &info);
3332 return info.stack_words > 0 ? info.reg_words * UNITS_PER_WORD : 0;
3336 /* Implement FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY. Every parameter gets at least
3337 PARM_BOUNDARY bits of alignment, but will be given anything up
3338 to STACK_BOUNDARY bits if the type requires it. */
3341 function_arg_boundary (enum machine_mode mode, tree type)
3343 unsigned int alignment;
3345 alignment = type ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode);
3346 if (alignment < PARM_BOUNDARY)
3347 alignment = PARM_BOUNDARY;
3348 if (alignment > STACK_BOUNDARY)
3349 alignment = STACK_BOUNDARY;
3350 return alignment;
3353 /* Return true if FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (MODE, TYPE) should return
3354 upward rather than downward. In other words, return true if the
3355 first byte of the stack slot has useful data, false if the last
3356 byte does. */
3358 bool
3359 mips_pad_arg_upward (enum machine_mode mode, tree type)
3361 /* On little-endian targets, the first byte of every stack argument
3362 is passed in the first byte of the stack slot. */
3363 if (!BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
3364 return true;
3366 /* Otherwise, integral types are padded downward: the last byte of a
3367 stack argument is passed in the last byte of the stack slot. */
3368 if (type != 0
3369 ? INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type) || POINTER_TYPE_P (type)
3370 : GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT)
3371 return false;
3373 /* Big-endian o64 pads floating-point arguments downward. */
3374 if (mips_abi == ABI_O64)
3375 if (type != 0 ? FLOAT_TYPE_P (type) : GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT)
3376 return false;
3378 /* Other types are padded upward for o32, o64, n32 and n64. */
3379 if (mips_abi != ABI_EABI)
3380 return true;
3382 /* Arguments smaller than a stack slot are padded downward. */
3383 if (mode != BLKmode)
3384 return (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) >= PARM_BOUNDARY);
3385 else
3386 return (int_size_in_bytes (type) >= (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT));
3390 /* Likewise BLOCK_REG_PADDING (MODE, TYPE, ...). Return !BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
3391 if the least significant byte of the register has useful data. Return
3392 the opposite if the most significant byte does. */
3394 bool
3395 mips_pad_reg_upward (enum machine_mode mode, tree type)
3397 /* No shifting is required for floating-point arguments. */
3398 if (type != 0 ? FLOAT_TYPE_P (type) : GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT)
3399 return !BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN;
3401 /* Otherwise, apply the same padding to register arguments as we do
3402 to stack arguments. */
3403 return mips_pad_arg_upward (mode, type);
3406 static void
3407 mips_setup_incoming_varargs (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum, enum machine_mode mode,
3408 tree type, int *pretend_size, int no_rtl)
3410 CUMULATIVE_ARGS local_cum;
3411 int gp_saved, fp_saved;
3413 /* The caller has advanced CUM up to, but not beyond, the last named
3414 argument. Advance a local copy of CUM past the last "real" named
3415 argument, to find out how many registers are left over. */
3417 local_cum = *cum;
3418 FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (local_cum, mode, type, 1);
3420 /* Found out how many registers we need to save. */
3421 gp_saved = MAX_ARGS_IN_REGISTERS - local_cum.num_gprs;
3422 fp_saved = (EABI_FLOAT_VARARGS_P
3423 ? MAX_ARGS_IN_REGISTERS - local_cum.num_fprs
3424 : 0);
3426 if (!no_rtl)
3428 if (gp_saved > 0)
3430 rtx ptr, mem;
3432 ptr = virtual_incoming_args_rtx;
3433 switch (mips_abi)
3435 case ABI_32:
3436 case ABI_O64:
3437 ptr = plus_constant (ptr, local_cum.num_gprs * UNITS_PER_WORD);
3438 break;
3440 case ABI_EABI:
3441 ptr = plus_constant (ptr, -gp_saved * UNITS_PER_WORD);
3442 break;
3444 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, ptr);
3445 set_mem_alias_set (mem, get_varargs_alias_set ());
3447 move_block_from_reg (local_cum.num_gprs + GP_ARG_FIRST,
3448 mem, gp_saved);
3450 if (fp_saved > 0)
3452 /* We can't use move_block_from_reg, because it will use
3453 the wrong mode. */
3454 enum machine_mode mode;
3455 int off, i;
3457 /* Set OFF to the offset from virtual_incoming_args_rtx of
3458 the first float register. The FP save area lies below
3459 the integer one, and is aligned to UNITS_PER_FPVALUE bytes. */
3460 off = -gp_saved * UNITS_PER_WORD;
3461 off &= ~(UNITS_PER_FPVALUE - 1);
3462 off -= fp_saved * UNITS_PER_FPREG;
3464 mode = TARGET_SINGLE_FLOAT ? SFmode : DFmode;
3466 for (i = local_cum.num_fprs; i < MAX_ARGS_IN_REGISTERS; i += FP_INC)
3468 rtx ptr, mem;
3470 ptr = plus_constant (virtual_incoming_args_rtx, off);
3471 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, ptr);
3472 set_mem_alias_set (mem, get_varargs_alias_set ());
3473 emit_move_insn (mem, gen_rtx_REG (mode, FP_ARG_FIRST + i));
3474 off += UNITS_PER_HWFPVALUE;
3478 if (TARGET_OLDABI)
3480 /* No need for pretend arguments: the register parameter area was
3481 allocated by the caller. */
3482 *pretend_size = 0;
3483 return;
3485 *pretend_size = (gp_saved * UNITS_PER_WORD) + (fp_saved * UNITS_PER_FPREG);
3488 /* Create the va_list data type.
3489 We keep 3 pointers, and two offsets.
3490 Two pointers are to the overflow area, which starts at the CFA.
3491 One of these is constant, for addressing into the GPR save area below it.
3492 The other is advanced up the stack through the overflow region.
3493 The third pointer is to the GPR save area. Since the FPR save area
3494 is just below it, we can address FPR slots off this pointer.
3495 We also keep two one-byte offsets, which are to be subtracted from the
3496 constant pointers to yield addresses in the GPR and FPR save areas.
3497 These are downcounted as float or non-float arguments are used,
3498 and when they get to zero, the argument must be obtained from the
3499 overflow region.
3500 If !EABI_FLOAT_VARARGS_P, then no FPR save area exists, and a single
3501 pointer is enough. It's started at the GPR save area, and is
3502 advanced, period.
3503 Note that the GPR save area is not constant size, due to optimization
3504 in the prologue. Hence, we can't use a design with two pointers
3505 and two offsets, although we could have designed this with two pointers
3506 and three offsets. */
3508 static tree
3509 mips_build_builtin_va_list (void)
3511 if (EABI_FLOAT_VARARGS_P)
3513 tree f_ovfl, f_gtop, f_ftop, f_goff, f_foff, f_res, record;
3514 tree array, index;
3516 record = (*lang_hooks.types.make_type) (RECORD_TYPE);
3518 f_ovfl = build_decl (FIELD_DECL, get_identifier ("__overflow_argptr"),
3519 ptr_type_node);
3520 f_gtop = build_decl (FIELD_DECL, get_identifier ("__gpr_top"),
3521 ptr_type_node);
3522 f_ftop = build_decl (FIELD_DECL, get_identifier ("__fpr_top"),
3523 ptr_type_node);
3524 f_goff = build_decl (FIELD_DECL, get_identifier ("__gpr_offset"),
3525 unsigned_char_type_node);
3526 f_foff = build_decl (FIELD_DECL, get_identifier ("__fpr_offset"),
3527 unsigned_char_type_node);
3528 /* Explicitly pad to the size of a pointer, so that -Wpadded won't
3529 warn on every user file. */
3530 index = build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, GET_MODE_SIZE (ptr_mode) - 2 - 1);
3531 array = build_array_type (unsigned_char_type_node,
3532 build_index_type (index));
3533 f_res = build_decl (FIELD_DECL, get_identifier ("__reserved"), array);
3535 DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (f_ovfl) = record;
3536 DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (f_gtop) = record;
3537 DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (f_ftop) = record;
3538 DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (f_goff) = record;
3539 DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (f_foff) = record;
3540 DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (f_res) = record;
3542 TYPE_FIELDS (record) = f_ovfl;
3543 TREE_CHAIN (f_ovfl) = f_gtop;
3544 TREE_CHAIN (f_gtop) = f_ftop;
3545 TREE_CHAIN (f_ftop) = f_goff;
3546 TREE_CHAIN (f_goff) = f_foff;
3547 TREE_CHAIN (f_foff) = f_res;
3549 layout_type (record);
3550 return record;
3552 else if (TARGET_IRIX && TARGET_IRIX6)
3553 /* On IRIX 6, this type is 'char *'. */
3554 return build_pointer_type (char_type_node);
3555 else
3556 /* Otherwise, we use 'void *'. */
3557 return ptr_type_node;
3560 /* Implement va_start. */
3562 void
3563 mips_va_start (tree valist, rtx nextarg)
3565 const CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum = &current_function_args_info;
3567 /* ARG_POINTER_REGNUM is initialized to STACK_POINTER_BOUNDARY, but
3568 since the stack is aligned for a pair of argument-passing slots,
3569 and the beginning of a variable argument list may be an odd slot,
3570 we have to decrease its alignment. */
3571 if (cfun && cfun->emit->regno_pointer_align)
3572 while (((current_function_pretend_args_size * BITS_PER_UNIT)
3573 & (REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (ARG_POINTER_REGNUM) - 1)) != 0)
3574 REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (ARG_POINTER_REGNUM) /= 2;
3576 if (mips_abi == ABI_EABI)
3578 int gpr_save_area_size;
3580 gpr_save_area_size
3581 = (MAX_ARGS_IN_REGISTERS - cum->num_gprs) * UNITS_PER_WORD;
3583 if (EABI_FLOAT_VARARGS_P)
3585 tree f_ovfl, f_gtop, f_ftop, f_goff, f_foff;
3586 tree ovfl, gtop, ftop, goff, foff;
3587 tree t;
3588 int fpr_offset;
3589 int fpr_save_area_size;
3591 f_ovfl = TYPE_FIELDS (va_list_type_node);
3592 f_gtop = TREE_CHAIN (f_ovfl);
3593 f_ftop = TREE_CHAIN (f_gtop);
3594 f_goff = TREE_CHAIN (f_ftop);
3595 f_foff = TREE_CHAIN (f_goff);
3597 ovfl = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_ovfl), valist, f_ovfl,
3598 NULL_TREE);
3599 gtop = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_gtop), valist, f_gtop,
3600 NULL_TREE);
3601 ftop = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_ftop), valist, f_ftop,
3602 NULL_TREE);
3603 goff = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_goff), valist, f_goff,
3604 NULL_TREE);
3605 foff = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_foff), valist, f_foff,
3606 NULL_TREE);
3608 /* Emit code to initialize OVFL, which points to the next varargs
3609 stack argument. CUM->STACK_WORDS gives the number of stack
3610 words used by named arguments. */
3611 t = make_tree (TREE_TYPE (ovfl), virtual_incoming_args_rtx);
3612 if (cum->stack_words > 0)
3613 t = build (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (ovfl), t,
3614 build_int_cst (NULL_TREE,
3615 cum->stack_words * UNITS_PER_WORD));
3616 t = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (ovfl), ovfl, t);
3617 expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
3619 /* Emit code to initialize GTOP, the top of the GPR save area. */
3620 t = make_tree (TREE_TYPE (gtop), virtual_incoming_args_rtx);
3621 t = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (gtop), gtop, t);
3622 expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
3624 /* Emit code to initialize FTOP, the top of the FPR save area.
3625 This address is gpr_save_area_bytes below GTOP, rounded
3626 down to the next fp-aligned boundary. */
3627 t = make_tree (TREE_TYPE (ftop), virtual_incoming_args_rtx);
3628 fpr_offset = gpr_save_area_size + UNITS_PER_FPVALUE - 1;
3629 fpr_offset &= ~(UNITS_PER_FPVALUE - 1);
3630 if (fpr_offset)
3631 t = build (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (ftop), t,
3632 build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, -fpr_offset));
3633 t = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (ftop), ftop, t);
3634 expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
3636 /* Emit code to initialize GOFF, the offset from GTOP of the
3637 next GPR argument. */
3638 t = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (goff), goff,
3639 build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, gpr_save_area_size));
3640 expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
3642 /* Likewise emit code to initialize FOFF, the offset from FTOP
3643 of the next FPR argument. */
3644 fpr_save_area_size
3645 = (MAX_ARGS_IN_REGISTERS - cum->num_fprs) * UNITS_PER_FPREG;
3646 t = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (foff), foff,
3647 build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, fpr_save_area_size));
3648 expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
3650 else
3652 /* Everything is in the GPR save area, or in the overflow
3653 area which is contiguous with it. */
3654 nextarg = plus_constant (nextarg, -gpr_save_area_size);
3655 std_expand_builtin_va_start (valist, nextarg);
3658 else
3659 std_expand_builtin_va_start (valist, nextarg);
3662 /* Implement va_arg. */
3664 static tree
3665 mips_gimplify_va_arg_expr (tree valist, tree type, tree *pre_p, tree *post_p)
3667 HOST_WIDE_INT size, rsize;
3668 tree addr;
3669 bool indirect;
3671 indirect = pass_by_reference (NULL, TYPE_MODE (type), type, 0);
3673 if (indirect)
3674 type = build_pointer_type (type);
3676 size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
3677 rsize = (size + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) & -UNITS_PER_WORD;
3679 if (mips_abi != ABI_EABI || !EABI_FLOAT_VARARGS_P)
3680 addr = std_gimplify_va_arg_expr (valist, type, pre_p, post_p);
3681 else
3683 /* Not a simple merged stack. */
3685 tree f_ovfl, f_gtop, f_ftop, f_goff, f_foff;
3686 tree ovfl, top, off, align;
3687 HOST_WIDE_INT osize;
3688 tree t, u;
3690 f_ovfl = TYPE_FIELDS (va_list_type_node);
3691 f_gtop = TREE_CHAIN (f_ovfl);
3692 f_ftop = TREE_CHAIN (f_gtop);
3693 f_goff = TREE_CHAIN (f_ftop);
3694 f_foff = TREE_CHAIN (f_goff);
3696 /* We maintain separate pointers and offsets for floating-point
3697 and integer arguments, but we need similar code in both cases.
3698 Let:
3700 TOP be the top of the register save area;
3701 OFF be the offset from TOP of the next register;
3702 ADDR_RTX be the address of the argument;
3703 RSIZE be the number of bytes used to store the argument
3704 when it's in the register save area;
3705 OSIZE be the number of bytes used to store it when it's
3706 in the stack overflow area; and
3707 PADDING be (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? OSIZE - RSIZE : 0)
3709 The code we want is:
3711 1: off &= -rsize; // round down
3712 2: if (off != 0)
3713 3: {
3714 4: addr_rtx = top - off;
3715 5: off -= rsize;
3716 6: }
3717 7: else
3718 8: {
3719 9: ovfl += ((intptr_t) ovfl + osize - 1) & -osize;
3720 10: addr_rtx = ovfl + PADDING;
3721 11: ovfl += osize;
3722 14: }
3724 [1] and [9] can sometimes be optimized away. */
3726 ovfl = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_ovfl), valist, f_ovfl,
3727 NULL_TREE);
3729 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (TYPE_MODE (type)) == MODE_FLOAT
3730 && GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (type)) <= UNITS_PER_FPVALUE)
3732 top = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_ftop), valist, f_ftop,
3733 NULL_TREE);
3734 off = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_foff), valist, f_foff,
3735 NULL_TREE);
3737 /* When floating-point registers are saved to the stack,
3738 each one will take up UNITS_PER_HWFPVALUE bytes, regardless
3739 of the float's precision. */
3740 rsize = UNITS_PER_HWFPVALUE;
3742 /* Overflow arguments are padded to UNITS_PER_WORD bytes
3743 (= PARM_BOUNDARY bits). This can be different from RSIZE
3744 in two cases:
3746 (1) On 32-bit targets when TYPE is a structure such as:
3748 struct s { float f; };
3750 Such structures are passed in paired FPRs, so RSIZE
3751 will be 8 bytes. However, the structure only takes
3752 up 4 bytes of memory, so OSIZE will only be 4.
3754 (2) In combinations such as -mgp64 -msingle-float
3755 -fshort-double. Doubles passed in registers
3756 will then take up 4 (UNITS_PER_HWFPVALUE) bytes,
3757 but those passed on the stack take up
3758 UNITS_PER_WORD bytes. */
3759 osize = MAX (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (type)), UNITS_PER_WORD);
3761 else
3763 top = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_gtop), valist, f_gtop,
3764 NULL_TREE);
3765 off = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (f_goff), valist, f_goff,
3766 NULL_TREE);
3767 if (rsize > UNITS_PER_WORD)
3769 /* [1] Emit code for: off &= -rsize. */
3770 t = build (BIT_AND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (off), off,
3771 build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, -rsize));
3772 t = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (off), off, t);
3773 gimplify_and_add (t, pre_p);
3775 osize = rsize;
3778 /* [2] Emit code to branch if off == 0. */
3779 t = lang_hooks.truthvalue_conversion (off);
3780 addr = build (COND_EXPR, ptr_type_node, t, NULL, NULL);
3782 /* [5] Emit code for: off -= rsize. We do this as a form of
3783 post-increment not available to C. Also widen for the
3784 coming pointer arithmetic. */
3785 t = fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (off), build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, rsize));
3786 t = build (POSTDECREMENT_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (off), off, t);
3787 t = fold_convert (sizetype, t);
3788 t = fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (top), t);
3790 /* [4] Emit code for: addr_rtx = top - off. On big endian machines,
3791 the argument has RSIZE - SIZE bytes of leading padding. */
3792 t = build (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (top), top, t);
3793 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && rsize > size)
3795 u = fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (t), build_int_cst (NULL_TREE,
3796 rsize - size));
3797 t = build (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (t), t, u);
3799 COND_EXPR_THEN (addr) = t;
3801 if (osize > UNITS_PER_WORD)
3803 /* [9] Emit: ovfl += ((intptr_t) ovfl + osize - 1) & -osize. */
3804 u = fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (ovfl),
3805 build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, osize - 1));
3806 t = build (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (ovfl), ovfl, u);
3807 u = fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (ovfl),
3808 build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, -osize));
3809 t = build (BIT_AND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (ovfl), t, u);
3810 align = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (ovfl), ovfl, t);
3812 else
3813 align = NULL;
3815 /* [10, 11]. Emit code to store ovfl in addr_rtx, then
3816 post-increment ovfl by osize. On big-endian machines,
3817 the argument has OSIZE - SIZE bytes of leading padding. */
3818 u = fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (ovfl),
3819 build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, osize));
3820 t = build (POSTINCREMENT_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (ovfl), ovfl, u);
3821 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && osize > size)
3823 u = fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (t),
3824 build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, osize - size));
3825 t = build (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (t), t, u);
3828 /* String [9] and [10,11] together. */
3829 if (align)
3830 t = build (COMPOUND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (t), align, t);
3831 COND_EXPR_ELSE (addr) = t;
3833 addr = fold_convert (build_pointer_type (type), addr);
3834 addr = build_fold_indirect_ref (addr);
3837 if (indirect)
3838 addr = build_fold_indirect_ref (addr);
3840 return addr;
3843 /* Return true if it is possible to use left/right accesses for a
3844 bitfield of WIDTH bits starting BITPOS bits into *OP. When
3845 returning true, update *OP, *LEFT and *RIGHT as follows:
3847 *OP is a BLKmode reference to the whole field.
3849 *LEFT is a QImode reference to the first byte if big endian or
3850 the last byte if little endian. This address can be used in the
3851 left-side instructions (lwl, swl, ldl, sdl).
3853 *RIGHT is a QImode reference to the opposite end of the field and
3854 can be used in the parterning right-side instruction. */
3856 static bool
3857 mips_get_unaligned_mem (rtx *op, unsigned int width, int bitpos,
3858 rtx *left, rtx *right)
3860 rtx first, last;
3862 /* Check that the operand really is a MEM. Not all the extv and
3863 extzv predicates are checked. */
3864 if (!MEM_P (*op))
3865 return false;
3867 /* Check that the size is valid. */
3868 if (width != 32 && (!TARGET_64BIT || width != 64))
3869 return false;
3871 /* We can only access byte-aligned values. Since we are always passed
3872 a reference to the first byte of the field, it is not necessary to
3873 do anything with BITPOS after this check. */
3874 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
3875 return false;
3877 /* Reject aligned bitfields: we want to use a normal load or store
3878 instead of a left/right pair. */
3879 if (MEM_ALIGN (*op) >= width)
3880 return false;
3882 /* Adjust *OP to refer to the whole field. This also has the effect
3883 of legitimizing *OP's address for BLKmode, possibly simplifying it. */
3884 *op = adjust_address (*op, BLKmode, 0);
3885 set_mem_size (*op, GEN_INT (width / BITS_PER_UNIT));
3887 /* Get references to both ends of the field. We deliberately don't
3888 use the original QImode *OP for FIRST since the new BLKmode one
3889 might have a simpler address. */
3890 first = adjust_address (*op, QImode, 0);
3891 last = adjust_address (*op, QImode, width / BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
3893 /* Allocate to LEFT and RIGHT according to endianness. LEFT should
3894 be the upper word and RIGHT the lower word. */
3895 if (TARGET_BIG_ENDIAN)
3896 *left = first, *right = last;
3897 else
3898 *left = last, *right = first;
3900 return true;
3904 /* Try to emit the equivalent of (set DEST (zero_extract SRC WIDTH BITPOS)).
3905 Return true on success. We only handle cases where zero_extract is
3906 equivalent to sign_extract. */
3908 bool
3909 mips_expand_unaligned_load (rtx dest, rtx src, unsigned int width, int bitpos)
3911 rtx left, right, temp;
3913 /* If TARGET_64BIT, the destination of a 32-bit load will be a
3914 paradoxical word_mode subreg. This is the only case in which
3915 we allow the destination to be larger than the source. */
3916 if (GET_CODE (dest) == SUBREG
3917 && GET_MODE (dest) == DImode
3918 && SUBREG_BYTE (dest) == 0
3919 && GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (dest)) == SImode)
3920 dest = SUBREG_REG (dest);
3922 /* After the above adjustment, the destination must be the same
3923 width as the source. */
3924 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (dest)) != width)
3925 return false;
3927 if (!mips_get_unaligned_mem (&src, width, bitpos, &left, &right))
3928 return false;
3930 temp = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (dest));
3931 if (GET_MODE (dest) == DImode)
3933 emit_insn (gen_mov_ldl (temp, src, left));
3934 emit_insn (gen_mov_ldr (dest, copy_rtx (src), right, temp));
3936 else
3938 emit_insn (gen_mov_lwl (temp, src, left));
3939 emit_insn (gen_mov_lwr (dest, copy_rtx (src), right, temp));
3941 return true;
3945 /* Try to expand (set (zero_extract DEST WIDTH BITPOS) SRC). Return
3946 true on success. */
3948 bool
3949 mips_expand_unaligned_store (rtx dest, rtx src, unsigned int width, int bitpos)
3951 rtx left, right;
3953 if (!mips_get_unaligned_mem (&dest, width, bitpos, &left, &right))
3954 return false;
3956 src = gen_lowpart (mode_for_size (width, MODE_INT, 0), src);
3958 if (GET_MODE (src) == DImode)
3960 emit_insn (gen_mov_sdl (dest, src, left));
3961 emit_insn (gen_mov_sdr (copy_rtx (dest), copy_rtx (src), right));
3963 else
3965 emit_insn (gen_mov_swl (dest, src, left));
3966 emit_insn (gen_mov_swr (copy_rtx (dest), copy_rtx (src), right));
3968 return true;
3971 /* Set up globals to generate code for the ISA or processor
3972 described by INFO. */
3974 static void
3975 mips_set_architecture (const struct mips_cpu_info *info)
3977 if (info != 0)
3979 mips_arch_info = info;
3980 mips_arch = info->cpu;
3981 mips_isa = info->isa;
3986 /* Likewise for tuning. */
3988 static void
3989 mips_set_tune (const struct mips_cpu_info *info)
3991 if (info != 0)
3993 mips_tune_info = info;
3994 mips_tune = info->cpu;
3999 /* Set up the threshold for data to go into the small data area, instead
4000 of the normal data area, and detect any conflicts in the switches. */
4002 void
4003 override_options (void)
4005 int i, start, regno;
4006 enum machine_mode mode;
4008 mips_section_threshold = g_switch_set ? g_switch_value : MIPS_DEFAULT_GVALUE;
4010 /* Interpret -mabi. */
4011 mips_abi = MIPS_ABI_DEFAULT;
4012 if (mips_abi_string != 0)
4014 if (strcmp (mips_abi_string, "32") == 0)
4015 mips_abi = ABI_32;
4016 else if (strcmp (mips_abi_string, "o64") == 0)
4017 mips_abi = ABI_O64;
4018 else if (strcmp (mips_abi_string, "n32") == 0)
4019 mips_abi = ABI_N32;
4020 else if (strcmp (mips_abi_string, "64") == 0)
4021 mips_abi = ABI_64;
4022 else if (strcmp (mips_abi_string, "eabi") == 0)
4023 mips_abi = ABI_EABI;
4024 else
4025 fatal_error ("bad value (%s) for -mabi= switch", mips_abi_string);
4028 /* The following code determines the architecture and register size.
4029 Similar code was added to GAS 2.14 (see tc-mips.c:md_after_parse_args()).
4030 The GAS and GCC code should be kept in sync as much as possible. */
4032 if (mips_arch_string != 0)
4033 mips_set_architecture (mips_parse_cpu ("-march", mips_arch_string));
4035 if (mips_isa_string != 0)
4037 /* Handle -mipsN. */
4038 char *whole_isa_str = concat ("mips", mips_isa_string, NULL);
4039 const struct mips_cpu_info *isa_info;
4041 isa_info = mips_parse_cpu ("-mips option", whole_isa_str);
4042 free (whole_isa_str);
4044 /* -march takes precedence over -mipsN, since it is more descriptive.
4045 There's no harm in specifying both as long as the ISA levels
4046 are the same. */
4047 if (mips_arch_info != 0 && mips_isa != isa_info->isa)
4048 error ("-mips%s conflicts with the other architecture options, "
4049 "which specify a MIPS%d processor",
4050 mips_isa_string, mips_isa);
4052 /* Set architecture based on the given option. */
4053 mips_set_architecture (isa_info);
4056 if (mips_arch_info == 0)
4058 #ifdef MIPS_CPU_STRING_DEFAULT
4059 mips_set_architecture (mips_parse_cpu ("default CPU",
4060 MIPS_CPU_STRING_DEFAULT));
4061 #else
4062 mips_set_architecture (mips_cpu_info_from_isa (MIPS_ISA_DEFAULT));
4063 #endif
4066 if (ABI_NEEDS_64BIT_REGS && !ISA_HAS_64BIT_REGS)
4067 error ("-march=%s is not compatible with the selected ABI",
4068 mips_arch_info->name);
4070 /* Optimize for mips_arch, unless -mtune selects a different processor. */
4071 if (mips_tune_string != 0)
4072 mips_set_tune (mips_parse_cpu ("-mtune", mips_tune_string));
4074 if (mips_tune_info == 0)
4075 mips_set_tune (mips_arch_info);
4077 if ((target_flags_explicit & MASK_64BIT) != 0)
4079 /* The user specified the size of the integer registers. Make sure
4080 it agrees with the ABI and ISA. */
4081 if (TARGET_64BIT && !ISA_HAS_64BIT_REGS)
4082 error ("-mgp64 used with a 32-bit processor");
4083 else if (!TARGET_64BIT && ABI_NEEDS_64BIT_REGS)
4084 error ("-mgp32 used with a 64-bit ABI");
4085 else if (TARGET_64BIT && ABI_NEEDS_32BIT_REGS)
4086 error ("-mgp64 used with a 32-bit ABI");
4088 else
4090 /* Infer the integer register size from the ABI and processor.
4091 Restrict ourselves to 32-bit registers if that's all the
4092 processor has, or if the ABI cannot handle 64-bit registers. */
4093 if (ABI_NEEDS_32BIT_REGS || !ISA_HAS_64BIT_REGS)
4094 target_flags &= ~MASK_64BIT;
4095 else
4096 target_flags |= MASK_64BIT;
4099 if ((target_flags_explicit & MASK_FLOAT64) != 0)
4101 /* Really, -mfp32 and -mfp64 are ornamental options. There's
4102 only one right answer here. */
4103 if (TARGET_64BIT && TARGET_DOUBLE_FLOAT && !TARGET_FLOAT64)
4104 error ("unsupported combination: %s", "-mgp64 -mfp32 -mdouble-float");
4105 else if (!TARGET_64BIT && TARGET_FLOAT64)
4106 error ("unsupported combination: %s", "-mgp32 -mfp64");
4107 else if (TARGET_SINGLE_FLOAT && TARGET_FLOAT64)
4108 error ("unsupported combination: %s", "-mfp64 -msingle-float");
4110 else
4112 /* -msingle-float selects 32-bit float registers. Otherwise the
4113 float registers should be the same size as the integer ones. */
4114 if (TARGET_64BIT && TARGET_DOUBLE_FLOAT)
4115 target_flags |= MASK_FLOAT64;
4116 else
4117 target_flags &= ~MASK_FLOAT64;
4120 /* End of code shared with GAS. */
4122 if ((target_flags_explicit & MASK_LONG64) == 0)
4124 /* If no type size setting options (-mlong64,-mint64,-mlong32)
4125 were used, then set the type sizes. In the EABI in 64 bit mode,
4126 longs and pointers are 64 bits. Likewise for the SGI Irix6 N64
4127 ABI. */
4128 if ((mips_abi == ABI_EABI && TARGET_64BIT) || mips_abi == ABI_64)
4129 target_flags |= MASK_LONG64;
4130 else
4131 target_flags &= ~MASK_LONG64;
4134 /* Deprecate -mint64. Remove after 4.0 branches. */
4135 if ((target_flags_explicit & MASK_INT64) != 0)
4136 warning ("-mint64 is a deprecated option");
4138 if (MIPS_MARCH_CONTROLS_SOFT_FLOAT
4139 && (target_flags_explicit & MASK_SOFT_FLOAT) == 0)
4141 /* For some configurations, it is useful to have -march control
4142 the default setting of MASK_SOFT_FLOAT. */
4143 switch ((int) mips_arch)
4145 case PROCESSOR_R4100:
4146 case PROCESSOR_R4111:
4147 case PROCESSOR_R4120:
4148 case PROCESSOR_R4130:
4149 target_flags |= MASK_SOFT_FLOAT;
4150 break;
4152 default:
4153 target_flags &= ~MASK_SOFT_FLOAT;
4154 break;
4158 if (!TARGET_OLDABI)
4159 flag_pcc_struct_return = 0;
4161 if ((target_flags_explicit & MASK_BRANCHLIKELY) == 0)
4163 /* If neither -mbranch-likely nor -mno-branch-likely was given
4164 on the command line, set MASK_BRANCHLIKELY based on the target
4165 architecture.
4167 By default, we enable use of Branch Likely instructions on
4168 all architectures which support them with the following
4169 exceptions: when creating MIPS32 or MIPS64 code, and when
4170 tuning for architectures where their use tends to hurt
4171 performance.
4173 The MIPS32 and MIPS64 architecture specifications say "Software
4174 is strongly encouraged to avoid use of Branch Likely
4175 instructions, as they will be removed from a future revision
4176 of the [MIPS32 and MIPS64] architecture." Therefore, we do not
4177 issue those instructions unless instructed to do so by
4178 -mbranch-likely. */
4179 if (ISA_HAS_BRANCHLIKELY
4180 && !(ISA_MIPS32 || ISA_MIPS32R2 || ISA_MIPS64)
4181 && !(TUNE_MIPS5500 || TUNE_SB1))
4182 target_flags |= MASK_BRANCHLIKELY;
4183 else
4184 target_flags &= ~MASK_BRANCHLIKELY;
4186 if (TARGET_BRANCHLIKELY && !ISA_HAS_BRANCHLIKELY)
4187 warning ("generation of Branch Likely instructions enabled, but not supported by architecture");
4189 /* The effect of -mabicalls isn't defined for the EABI. */
4190 if (mips_abi == ABI_EABI && TARGET_ABICALLS)
4192 error ("unsupported combination: %s", "-mabicalls -mabi=eabi");
4193 target_flags &= ~MASK_ABICALLS;
4196 /* -fpic (-KPIC) is the default when TARGET_ABICALLS is defined. We need
4197 to set flag_pic so that the LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P macro will work. */
4198 /* ??? -non_shared turns off pic code generation, but this is not
4199 implemented. */
4200 if (TARGET_ABICALLS)
4202 flag_pic = 1;
4203 if (mips_section_threshold > 0)
4204 warning ("-G is incompatible with PIC code which is the default");
4207 /* mips_split_addresses is a half-way house between explicit
4208 relocations and the traditional assembler macros. It can
4209 split absolute 32-bit symbolic constants into a high/lo_sum
4210 pair but uses macros for other sorts of access.
4212 Like explicit relocation support for REL targets, it relies
4213 on GNU extensions in the assembler and the linker.
4215 Although this code should work for -O0, it has traditionally
4216 been treated as an optimization. */
4217 if (!TARGET_MIPS16 && TARGET_SPLIT_ADDRESSES
4218 && optimize && !flag_pic
4219 && !ABI_HAS_64BIT_SYMBOLS)
4220 mips_split_addresses = 1;
4221 else
4222 mips_split_addresses = 0;
4224 /* -mvr4130-align is a "speed over size" optimization: it usually produces
4225 faster code, but at the expense of more nops. Enable it at -O3 and
4226 above. */
4227 if (optimize > 2 && (target_flags_explicit & MASK_VR4130_ALIGN) == 0)
4228 target_flags |= MASK_VR4130_ALIGN;
4230 /* When compiling for the mips16, we cannot use floating point. We
4231 record the original hard float value in mips16_hard_float. */
4232 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
4234 if (TARGET_SOFT_FLOAT)
4235 mips16_hard_float = 0;
4236 else
4237 mips16_hard_float = 1;
4238 target_flags |= MASK_SOFT_FLOAT;
4240 /* Don't run the scheduler before reload, since it tends to
4241 increase register pressure. */
4242 flag_schedule_insns = 0;
4244 /* Don't do hot/cold partitioning. The constant layout code expects
4245 the whole function to be in a single section. */
4246 flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition = 0;
4248 /* Silently disable -mexplicit-relocs since it doesn't apply
4249 to mips16 code. Even so, it would overly pedantic to warn
4250 about "-mips16 -mexplicit-relocs", especially given that
4251 we use a %gprel() operator. */
4252 target_flags &= ~MASK_EXPLICIT_RELOCS;
4255 /* When using explicit relocs, we call dbr_schedule from within
4256 mips_reorg. */
4257 if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS)
4259 mips_flag_delayed_branch = flag_delayed_branch;
4260 flag_delayed_branch = 0;
4263 #ifdef MIPS_TFMODE_FORMAT
4264 REAL_MODE_FORMAT (TFmode) = &MIPS_TFMODE_FORMAT;
4265 #endif
4267 /* Make sure that the user didn't turn off paired single support when
4268 MIPS-3D support is requested. */
4269 if (TARGET_MIPS3D && (target_flags_explicit & MASK_PAIRED_SINGLE)
4270 && !TARGET_PAIRED_SINGLE_FLOAT)
4271 error ("-mips3d requires -mpaired-single");
4273 /* If TARGET_MIPS3D, enable MASK_PAIRED_SINGLE. */
4274 if (TARGET_MIPS3D)
4275 target_flags |= MASK_PAIRED_SINGLE;
4277 /* Make sure that when TARGET_PAIRED_SINGLE_FLOAT is true, TARGET_FLOAT64
4278 and TARGET_HARD_FLOAT are both true. */
4279 if (TARGET_PAIRED_SINGLE_FLOAT && !(TARGET_FLOAT64 && TARGET_HARD_FLOAT))
4280 error ("-mips3d/-mpaired-single must be used with -mfp64 -mhard-float");
4282 /* Make sure that the ISA supports TARGET_PAIRED_SINGLE_FLOAT when it is
4283 enabled. */
4284 if (TARGET_PAIRED_SINGLE_FLOAT && !ISA_MIPS64)
4285 error ("-mips3d/-mpaired-single must be used with -mips64");
4287 mips_print_operand_punct['?'] = 1;
4288 mips_print_operand_punct['#'] = 1;
4289 mips_print_operand_punct['/'] = 1;
4290 mips_print_operand_punct['&'] = 1;
4291 mips_print_operand_punct['!'] = 1;
4292 mips_print_operand_punct['*'] = 1;
4293 mips_print_operand_punct['@'] = 1;
4294 mips_print_operand_punct['.'] = 1;
4295 mips_print_operand_punct['('] = 1;
4296 mips_print_operand_punct[')'] = 1;
4297 mips_print_operand_punct['['] = 1;
4298 mips_print_operand_punct[']'] = 1;
4299 mips_print_operand_punct['<'] = 1;
4300 mips_print_operand_punct['>'] = 1;
4301 mips_print_operand_punct['{'] = 1;
4302 mips_print_operand_punct['}'] = 1;
4303 mips_print_operand_punct['^'] = 1;
4304 mips_print_operand_punct['$'] = 1;
4305 mips_print_operand_punct['+'] = 1;
4306 mips_print_operand_punct['~'] = 1;
4308 mips_char_to_class['d'] = TARGET_MIPS16 ? M16_REGS : GR_REGS;
4309 mips_char_to_class['t'] = T_REG;
4310 mips_char_to_class['f'] = (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT ? FP_REGS : NO_REGS);
4311 mips_char_to_class['h'] = HI_REG;
4312 mips_char_to_class['l'] = LO_REG;
4313 mips_char_to_class['x'] = MD_REGS;
4314 mips_char_to_class['b'] = ALL_REGS;
4315 mips_char_to_class['c'] = (TARGET_ABICALLS ? PIC_FN_ADDR_REG :
4316 TARGET_MIPS16 ? M16_NA_REGS :
4317 GR_REGS);
4318 mips_char_to_class['e'] = LEA_REGS;
4319 mips_char_to_class['j'] = PIC_FN_ADDR_REG;
4320 mips_char_to_class['y'] = GR_REGS;
4321 mips_char_to_class['z'] = ST_REGS;
4322 mips_char_to_class['B'] = COP0_REGS;
4323 mips_char_to_class['C'] = COP2_REGS;
4324 mips_char_to_class['D'] = COP3_REGS;
4326 /* Set up array to map GCC register number to debug register number.
4327 Ignore the special purpose register numbers. */
4329 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
4330 mips_dbx_regno[i] = -1;
4332 start = GP_DBX_FIRST - GP_REG_FIRST;
4333 for (i = GP_REG_FIRST; i <= GP_REG_LAST; i++)
4334 mips_dbx_regno[i] = i + start;
4336 start = FP_DBX_FIRST - FP_REG_FIRST;
4337 for (i = FP_REG_FIRST; i <= FP_REG_LAST; i++)
4338 mips_dbx_regno[i] = i + start;
4340 mips_dbx_regno[HI_REGNUM] = MD_DBX_FIRST + 0;
4341 mips_dbx_regno[LO_REGNUM] = MD_DBX_FIRST + 1;
4343 /* Set up array giving whether a given register can hold a given mode. */
4345 for (mode = VOIDmode;
4346 mode != MAX_MACHINE_MODE;
4347 mode = (enum machine_mode) ((int)mode + 1))
4349 register int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
4350 register enum mode_class class = GET_MODE_CLASS (mode);
4352 for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; regno++)
4354 register int temp;
4356 if (mode == CCV2mode)
4357 temp = (ISA_HAS_8CC
4358 && ST_REG_P (regno)
4359 && (regno - ST_REG_FIRST) % 2 == 0);
4361 else if (mode == CCV4mode)
4362 temp = (ISA_HAS_8CC
4363 && ST_REG_P (regno)
4364 && (regno - ST_REG_FIRST) % 4 == 0);
4366 else if (mode == CCmode)
4368 if (! ISA_HAS_8CC)
4369 temp = (regno == FPSW_REGNUM);
4370 else
4371 temp = (ST_REG_P (regno) || GP_REG_P (regno)
4372 || FP_REG_P (regno));
4375 else if (GP_REG_P (regno))
4376 temp = ((regno & 1) == 0 || size <= UNITS_PER_WORD);
4378 else if (FP_REG_P (regno))
4379 temp = ((regno % FP_INC) == 0)
4380 && (((class == MODE_FLOAT || class == MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT
4381 || class == MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT)
4382 && size <= UNITS_PER_FPVALUE)
4383 /* Allow integer modes that fit into a single
4384 register. We need to put integers into FPRs
4385 when using instructions like cvt and trunc. */
4386 || (class == MODE_INT && size <= UNITS_PER_FPREG)
4387 /* Allow TFmode for CCmode reloads. */
4388 || (ISA_HAS_8CC && mode == TFmode));
4390 else if (MD_REG_P (regno))
4391 temp = (INTEGRAL_MODE_P (mode)
4392 && (size <= UNITS_PER_WORD
4393 || (regno == MD_REG_FIRST
4394 && size == 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD)));
4396 else if (ALL_COP_REG_P (regno))
4397 temp = (class == MODE_INT && size <= UNITS_PER_WORD);
4398 else
4399 temp = 0;
4401 mips_hard_regno_mode_ok[(int)mode][regno] = temp;
4405 /* Save GPR registers in word_mode sized hunks. word_mode hasn't been
4406 initialized yet, so we can't use that here. */
4407 gpr_mode = TARGET_64BIT ? DImode : SImode;
4409 /* Provide default values for align_* for 64-bit targets. */
4410 if (TARGET_64BIT && !TARGET_MIPS16)
4412 if (align_loops == 0)
4413 align_loops = 8;
4414 if (align_jumps == 0)
4415 align_jumps = 8;
4416 if (align_functions == 0)
4417 align_functions = 8;
4420 /* Function to allocate machine-dependent function status. */
4421 init_machine_status = &mips_init_machine_status;
4423 if (ABI_HAS_64BIT_SYMBOLS)
4425 if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS)
4427 mips_split_p[SYMBOL_64_HIGH] = true;
4428 mips_hi_relocs[SYMBOL_64_HIGH] = "%highest(";
4429 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_64_HIGH] = "%higher(";
4431 mips_split_p[SYMBOL_64_MID] = true;
4432 mips_hi_relocs[SYMBOL_64_MID] = "%higher(";
4433 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_64_MID] = "%hi(";
4435 mips_split_p[SYMBOL_64_LOW] = true;
4436 mips_hi_relocs[SYMBOL_64_LOW] = "%hi(";
4437 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_64_LOW] = "%lo(";
4439 mips_split_p[SYMBOL_GENERAL] = true;
4440 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_GENERAL] = "%lo(";
4443 else
4445 if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS || mips_split_addresses)
4447 mips_split_p[SYMBOL_GENERAL] = true;
4448 mips_hi_relocs[SYMBOL_GENERAL] = "%hi(";
4449 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_GENERAL] = "%lo(";
4453 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
4455 /* The high part is provided by a pseudo copy of $gp. */
4456 mips_split_p[SYMBOL_SMALL_DATA] = true;
4457 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_SMALL_DATA] = "%gprel(";
4460 if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS)
4462 /* Small data constants are kept whole until after reload,
4463 then lowered by mips_rewrite_small_data. */
4464 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_SMALL_DATA] = "%gp_rel(";
4466 mips_split_p[SYMBOL_GOT_LOCAL] = true;
4467 if (TARGET_NEWABI)
4469 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_PAGE] = "%got_page(";
4470 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_GOT_LOCAL] = "%got_ofst(";
4472 else
4474 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_PAGE] = "%got(";
4475 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_GOT_LOCAL] = "%lo(";
4478 if (TARGET_XGOT)
4480 /* The HIGH and LO_SUM are matched by special .md patterns. */
4481 mips_split_p[SYMBOL_GOT_GLOBAL] = true;
4483 mips_split_p[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_GLOBAL] = true;
4484 mips_hi_relocs[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_GLOBAL] = "%got_hi(";
4485 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_GLOBAL] = "%got_lo(";
4487 mips_split_p[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_CALL] = true;
4488 mips_hi_relocs[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_CALL] = "%call_hi(";
4489 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_CALL] = "%call_lo(";
4491 else
4493 if (TARGET_NEWABI)
4494 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_GLOBAL] = "%got_disp(";
4495 else
4496 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_GLOBAL] = "%got(";
4497 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_CALL] = "%call16(";
4501 if (TARGET_NEWABI)
4503 mips_split_p[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_LOADGP] = true;
4504 mips_hi_relocs[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_LOADGP] = "%hi(%neg(%gp_rel(";
4505 mips_lo_relocs[SYMBOL_GOTOFF_LOADGP] = "%lo(%neg(%gp_rel(";
4508 /* Default to working around R4000 errata only if the processor
4509 was selected explicitly. */
4510 if ((target_flags_explicit & MASK_FIX_R4000) == 0
4511 && mips_matching_cpu_name_p (mips_arch_info->name, "r4000"))
4512 target_flags |= MASK_FIX_R4000;
4514 /* Default to working around R4400 errata only if the processor
4515 was selected explicitly. */
4516 if ((target_flags_explicit & MASK_FIX_R4400) == 0
4517 && mips_matching_cpu_name_p (mips_arch_info->name, "r4400"))
4518 target_flags |= MASK_FIX_R4400;
4521 /* Implement CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE. */
4523 void
4524 mips_conditional_register_usage (void)
4526 if (!TARGET_HARD_FLOAT)
4528 int regno;
4530 for (regno = FP_REG_FIRST; regno <= FP_REG_LAST; regno++)
4531 fixed_regs[regno] = call_used_regs[regno] = 1;
4532 for (regno = ST_REG_FIRST; regno <= ST_REG_LAST; regno++)
4533 fixed_regs[regno] = call_used_regs[regno] = 1;
4535 else if (! ISA_HAS_8CC)
4537 int regno;
4539 /* We only have a single condition code register. We
4540 implement this by hiding all the condition code registers,
4541 and generating RTL that refers directly to ST_REG_FIRST. */
4542 for (regno = ST_REG_FIRST; regno <= ST_REG_LAST; regno++)
4543 fixed_regs[regno] = call_used_regs[regno] = 1;
4545 /* In mips16 mode, we permit the $t temporary registers to be used
4546 for reload. We prohibit the unused $s registers, since they
4547 are caller saved, and saving them via a mips16 register would
4548 probably waste more time than just reloading the value. */
4549 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
4551 fixed_regs[18] = call_used_regs[18] = 1;
4552 fixed_regs[19] = call_used_regs[19] = 1;
4553 fixed_regs[20] = call_used_regs[20] = 1;
4554 fixed_regs[21] = call_used_regs[21] = 1;
4555 fixed_regs[22] = call_used_regs[22] = 1;
4556 fixed_regs[23] = call_used_regs[23] = 1;
4557 fixed_regs[26] = call_used_regs[26] = 1;
4558 fixed_regs[27] = call_used_regs[27] = 1;
4559 fixed_regs[30] = call_used_regs[30] = 1;
4561 /* fp20-23 are now caller saved. */
4562 if (mips_abi == ABI_64)
4564 int regno;
4565 for (regno = FP_REG_FIRST + 20; regno < FP_REG_FIRST + 24; regno++)
4566 call_really_used_regs[regno] = call_used_regs[regno] = 1;
4568 /* Odd registers from fp21 to fp31 are now caller saved. */
4569 if (mips_abi == ABI_N32)
4571 int regno;
4572 for (regno = FP_REG_FIRST + 21; regno <= FP_REG_FIRST + 31; regno+=2)
4573 call_really_used_regs[regno] = call_used_regs[regno] = 1;
4577 /* Allocate a chunk of memory for per-function machine-dependent data. */
4578 static struct machine_function *
4579 mips_init_machine_status (void)
4581 return ((struct machine_function *)
4582 ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct machine_function)));
4585 /* On the mips16, we want to allocate $24 (T_REG) before other
4586 registers for instructions for which it is possible. This helps
4587 avoid shuffling registers around in order to set up for an xor,
4588 encouraging the compiler to use a cmp instead. */
4590 void
4591 mips_order_regs_for_local_alloc (void)
4593 register int i;
4595 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
4596 reg_alloc_order[i] = i;
4598 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
4600 /* It really doesn't matter where we put register 0, since it is
4601 a fixed register anyhow. */
4602 reg_alloc_order[0] = 24;
4603 reg_alloc_order[24] = 0;
4608 /* The MIPS debug format wants all automatic variables and arguments
4609 to be in terms of the virtual frame pointer (stack pointer before
4610 any adjustment in the function), while the MIPS 3.0 linker wants
4611 the frame pointer to be the stack pointer after the initial
4612 adjustment. So, we do the adjustment here. The arg pointer (which
4613 is eliminated) points to the virtual frame pointer, while the frame
4614 pointer (which may be eliminated) points to the stack pointer after
4615 the initial adjustments. */
4617 HOST_WIDE_INT
4618 mips_debugger_offset (rtx addr, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
4620 rtx offset2 = const0_rtx;
4621 rtx reg = eliminate_constant_term (addr, &offset2);
4623 if (offset == 0)
4624 offset = INTVAL (offset2);
4626 if (reg == stack_pointer_rtx || reg == frame_pointer_rtx
4627 || reg == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
4629 HOST_WIDE_INT frame_size = (!cfun->machine->frame.initialized)
4630 ? compute_frame_size (get_frame_size ())
4631 : cfun->machine->frame.total_size;
4633 /* MIPS16 frame is smaller */
4634 if (frame_pointer_needed && TARGET_MIPS16)
4635 frame_size -= cfun->machine->frame.args_size;
4637 offset = offset - frame_size;
4640 /* sdbout_parms does not want this to crash for unrecognized cases. */
4641 #if 0
4642 else if (reg != arg_pointer_rtx)
4643 fatal_insn ("mips_debugger_offset called with non stack/frame/arg pointer",
4644 addr);
4645 #endif
4647 return offset;
4650 /* Implement the PRINT_OPERAND macro. The MIPS-specific operand codes are:
4652 'X' OP is CONST_INT, prints 32 bits in hexadecimal format = "0x%08x",
4653 'x' OP is CONST_INT, prints 16 bits in hexadecimal format = "0x%04x",
4654 'h' OP is HIGH, prints %hi(X),
4655 'd' output integer constant in decimal,
4656 'z' if the operand is 0, use $0 instead of normal operand.
4657 'D' print second part of double-word register or memory operand.
4658 'L' print low-order register of double-word register operand.
4659 'M' print high-order register of double-word register operand.
4660 'C' print part of opcode for a branch condition.
4661 'F' print part of opcode for a floating-point branch condition.
4662 'N' print part of opcode for a branch condition, inverted.
4663 'W' print part of opcode for a floating-point branch condition, inverted.
4664 'T' print 'f' for (eq:CC ...), 't' for (ne:CC ...),
4665 'z' for (eq:?I ...), 'n' for (ne:?I ...).
4666 't' like 'T', but with the EQ/NE cases reversed
4667 'Y' for a CONST_INT X, print mips_fp_conditions[X]
4668 'Z' print the operand and a comma for ISA_HAS_8CC, otherwise print nothing
4669 'R' print the reloc associated with LO_SUM
4671 The punctuation characters are:
4673 '(' Turn on .set noreorder
4674 ')' Turn on .set reorder
4675 '[' Turn on .set noat
4676 ']' Turn on .set at
4677 '<' Turn on .set nomacro
4678 '>' Turn on .set macro
4679 '{' Turn on .set volatile (not GAS)
4680 '}' Turn on .set novolatile (not GAS)
4681 '&' Turn on .set noreorder if filling delay slots
4682 '*' Turn on both .set noreorder and .set nomacro if filling delay slots
4683 '!' Turn on .set nomacro if filling delay slots
4684 '#' Print nop if in a .set noreorder section.
4685 '/' Like '#', but does nothing within a delayed branch sequence
4686 '?' Print 'l' if we are to use a branch likely instead of normal branch.
4687 '@' Print the name of the assembler temporary register (at or $1).
4688 '.' Print the name of the register with a hard-wired zero (zero or $0).
4689 '^' Print the name of the pic call-through register (t9 or $25).
4690 '$' Print the name of the stack pointer register (sp or $29).
4691 '+' Print the name of the gp register (usually gp or $28).
4692 '~' Output a branch alignment to LABEL_ALIGN(NULL). */
4694 void
4695 print_operand (FILE *file, rtx op, int letter)
4697 register enum rtx_code code;
4699 if (PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (letter))
4701 switch (letter)
4703 case '?':
4704 if (mips_branch_likely)
4705 putc ('l', file);
4706 break;
4708 case '@':
4709 fputs (reg_names [GP_REG_FIRST + 1], file);
4710 break;
4712 case '^':
4713 fputs (reg_names [PIC_FUNCTION_ADDR_REGNUM], file);
4714 break;
4716 case '.':
4717 fputs (reg_names [GP_REG_FIRST + 0], file);
4718 break;
4720 case '$':
4721 fputs (reg_names[STACK_POINTER_REGNUM], file);
4722 break;
4724 case '+':
4725 fputs (reg_names[PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM], file);
4726 break;
4728 case '&':
4729 if (final_sequence != 0 && set_noreorder++ == 0)
4730 fputs (".set\tnoreorder\n\t", file);
4731 break;
4733 case '*':
4734 if (final_sequence != 0)
4736 if (set_noreorder++ == 0)
4737 fputs (".set\tnoreorder\n\t", file);
4739 if (set_nomacro++ == 0)
4740 fputs (".set\tnomacro\n\t", file);
4742 break;
4744 case '!':
4745 if (final_sequence != 0 && set_nomacro++ == 0)
4746 fputs ("\n\t.set\tnomacro", file);
4747 break;
4749 case '#':
4750 if (set_noreorder != 0)
4751 fputs ("\n\tnop", file);
4752 break;
4754 case '/':
4755 /* Print an extra newline so that the delayed insn is separated
4756 from the following ones. This looks neater and is consistent
4757 with non-nop delayed sequences. */
4758 if (set_noreorder != 0 && final_sequence == 0)
4759 fputs ("\n\tnop\n", file);
4760 break;
4762 case '(':
4763 if (set_noreorder++ == 0)
4764 fputs (".set\tnoreorder\n\t", file);
4765 break;
4767 case ')':
4768 if (set_noreorder == 0)
4769 error ("internal error: %%) found without a %%( in assembler pattern");
4771 else if (--set_noreorder == 0)
4772 fputs ("\n\t.set\treorder", file);
4774 break;
4776 case '[':
4777 if (set_noat++ == 0)
4778 fputs (".set\tnoat\n\t", file);
4779 break;
4781 case ']':
4782 if (set_noat == 0)
4783 error ("internal error: %%] found without a %%[ in assembler pattern");
4784 else if (--set_noat == 0)
4785 fputs ("\n\t.set\tat", file);
4787 break;
4789 case '<':
4790 if (set_nomacro++ == 0)
4791 fputs (".set\tnomacro\n\t", file);
4792 break;
4794 case '>':
4795 if (set_nomacro == 0)
4796 error ("internal error: %%> found without a %%< in assembler pattern");
4797 else if (--set_nomacro == 0)
4798 fputs ("\n\t.set\tmacro", file);
4800 break;
4802 case '{':
4803 if (set_volatile++ == 0)
4804 fputs ("#.set\tvolatile\n\t", file);
4805 break;
4807 case '}':
4808 if (set_volatile == 0)
4809 error ("internal error: %%} found without a %%{ in assembler pattern");
4810 else if (--set_volatile == 0)
4811 fputs ("\n\t#.set\tnovolatile", file);
4813 break;
4815 case '~':
4817 if (align_labels_log > 0)
4818 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (file, align_labels_log);
4820 break;
4822 default:
4823 error ("PRINT_OPERAND: unknown punctuation '%c'", letter);
4824 break;
4827 return;
4830 if (! op)
4832 error ("PRINT_OPERAND null pointer");
4833 return;
4836 code = GET_CODE (op);
4838 if (letter == 'C')
4839 switch (code)
4841 case EQ: fputs ("eq", file); break;
4842 case NE: fputs ("ne", file); break;
4843 case GT: fputs ("gt", file); break;
4844 case GE: fputs ("ge", file); break;
4845 case LT: fputs ("lt", file); break;
4846 case LE: fputs ("le", file); break;
4847 case GTU: fputs ("gtu", file); break;
4848 case GEU: fputs ("geu", file); break;
4849 case LTU: fputs ("ltu", file); break;
4850 case LEU: fputs ("leu", file); break;
4851 default:
4852 fatal_insn ("PRINT_OPERAND, invalid insn for %%C", op);
4855 else if (letter == 'N')
4856 switch (code)
4858 case EQ: fputs ("ne", file); break;
4859 case NE: fputs ("eq", file); break;
4860 case GT: fputs ("le", file); break;
4861 case GE: fputs ("lt", file); break;
4862 case LT: fputs ("ge", file); break;
4863 case LE: fputs ("gt", file); break;
4864 case GTU: fputs ("leu", file); break;
4865 case GEU: fputs ("ltu", file); break;
4866 case LTU: fputs ("geu", file); break;
4867 case LEU: fputs ("gtu", file); break;
4868 default:
4869 fatal_insn ("PRINT_OPERAND, invalid insn for %%N", op);
4872 else if (letter == 'F')
4873 switch (code)
4875 case EQ: fputs ("c1f", file); break;
4876 case NE: fputs ("c1t", file); break;
4877 default:
4878 fatal_insn ("PRINT_OPERAND, invalid insn for %%F", op);
4881 else if (letter == 'W')
4882 switch (code)
4884 case EQ: fputs ("c1t", file); break;
4885 case NE: fputs ("c1f", file); break;
4886 default:
4887 fatal_insn ("PRINT_OPERAND, invalid insn for %%W", op);
4890 else if (letter == 'h')
4892 if (GET_CODE (op) == HIGH)
4893 op = XEXP (op, 0);
4895 print_operand_reloc (file, op, mips_hi_relocs);
4898 else if (letter == 'R')
4899 print_operand_reloc (file, op, mips_lo_relocs);
4901 else if (letter == 'Y')
4903 if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT
4904 && ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (op)
4905 < ARRAY_SIZE (mips_fp_conditions)))
4906 fputs (mips_fp_conditions[INTVAL (op)], file);
4907 else
4908 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%Y value");
4911 else if (letter == 'Z')
4913 if (ISA_HAS_8CC)
4915 print_operand (file, op, 0);
4916 fputc (',', file);
4920 else if (code == REG || code == SUBREG)
4922 register int regnum;
4924 if (code == REG)
4925 regnum = REGNO (op);
4926 else
4927 regnum = true_regnum (op);
4929 if ((letter == 'M' && ! WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
4930 || (letter == 'L' && WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
4931 || letter == 'D')
4932 regnum++;
4934 fprintf (file, "%s", reg_names[regnum]);
4937 else if (code == MEM)
4939 if (letter == 'D')
4940 output_address (plus_constant (XEXP (op, 0), 4));
4941 else
4942 output_address (XEXP (op, 0));
4945 else if (letter == 'x' && GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT)
4946 fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX, 0xffff & INTVAL(op));
4948 else if (letter == 'X' && GET_CODE(op) == CONST_INT)
4949 fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX, INTVAL (op));
4951 else if (letter == 'd' && GET_CODE(op) == CONST_INT)
4952 fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, (INTVAL(op)));
4954 else if (letter == 'z' && op == CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (op)))
4955 fputs (reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST], file);
4957 else if (letter == 'd' || letter == 'x' || letter == 'X')
4958 output_operand_lossage ("invalid use of %%d, %%x, or %%X");
4960 else if (letter == 'T' || letter == 't')
4962 int truth = (code == NE) == (letter == 'T');
4963 fputc ("zfnt"[truth * 2 + (GET_MODE (op) == CCmode)], file);
4966 else if (CONST_GP_P (op))
4967 fputs (reg_names[GLOBAL_POINTER_REGNUM], file);
4969 else
4970 output_addr_const (file, op);
4974 /* Print symbolic operand OP, which is part of a HIGH or LO_SUM.
4975 RELOCS is the array of relocations to use. */
4977 static void
4978 print_operand_reloc (FILE *file, rtx op, const char **relocs)
4980 enum mips_symbol_type symbol_type;
4981 const char *p;
4982 rtx base;
4983 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
4985 if (!mips_symbolic_constant_p (op, &symbol_type) || relocs[symbol_type] == 0)
4986 fatal_insn ("PRINT_OPERAND, invalid operand for relocation", op);
4988 /* If OP uses an UNSPEC address, we want to print the inner symbol. */
4989 mips_split_const (op, &base, &offset);
4990 if (UNSPEC_ADDRESS_P (base))
4991 op = plus_constant (UNSPEC_ADDRESS (base), offset);
4993 fputs (relocs[symbol_type], file);
4994 output_addr_const (file, op);
4995 for (p = relocs[symbol_type]; *p != 0; p++)
4996 if (*p == '(')
4997 fputc (')', file);
5000 /* Output address operand X to FILE. */
5002 void
5003 print_operand_address (FILE *file, rtx x)
5005 struct mips_address_info addr;
5007 if (mips_classify_address (&addr, x, word_mode, true))
5008 switch (addr.type)
5010 case ADDRESS_REG:
5011 print_operand (file, addr.offset, 0);
5012 fprintf (file, "(%s)", reg_names[REGNO (addr.reg)]);
5013 return;
5015 case ADDRESS_LO_SUM:
5016 print_operand (file, addr.offset, 'R');
5017 fprintf (file, "(%s)", reg_names[REGNO (addr.reg)]);
5018 return;
5020 case ADDRESS_CONST_INT:
5021 output_addr_const (file, x);
5022 fprintf (file, "(%s)", reg_names[0]);
5023 return;
5025 case ADDRESS_SYMBOLIC:
5026 output_addr_const (file, x);
5027 return;
5029 gcc_unreachable ();
5032 /* When using assembler macros, keep track of all of small-data externs
5033 so that mips_file_end can emit the appropriate declarations for them.
5035 In most cases it would be safe (though pointless) to emit .externs
5036 for other symbols too. One exception is when an object is within
5037 the -G limit but declared by the user to be in a section other
5038 than .sbss or .sdata. */
5041 mips_output_external (FILE *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, tree decl, const char *name)
5043 register struct extern_list *p;
5045 if (!TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS && mips_in_small_data_p (decl))
5047 p = (struct extern_list *) ggc_alloc (sizeof (struct extern_list));
5048 p->next = extern_head;
5049 p->name = name;
5050 p->size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (decl));
5051 extern_head = p;
5054 if (TARGET_IRIX && mips_abi == ABI_32 && TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
5056 p = (struct extern_list *) ggc_alloc (sizeof (struct extern_list));
5057 p->next = extern_head;
5058 p->name = name;
5059 p->size = -1;
5060 extern_head = p;
5063 return 0;
5066 #if TARGET_IRIX
5067 static void
5068 irix_output_external_libcall (rtx fun)
5070 register struct extern_list *p;
5072 if (mips_abi == ABI_32)
5074 p = (struct extern_list *) ggc_alloc (sizeof (struct extern_list));
5075 p->next = extern_head;
5076 p->name = XSTR (fun, 0);
5077 p->size = -1;
5078 extern_head = p;
5081 #endif
5083 /* Emit a new filename to a stream. If we are smuggling stabs, try to
5084 put out a MIPS ECOFF file and a stab. */
5086 void
5087 mips_output_filename (FILE *stream, const char *name)
5090 /* If we are emitting DWARF-2, let dwarf2out handle the ".file"
5091 directives. */
5092 if (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG)
5093 return;
5094 else if (mips_output_filename_first_time)
5096 mips_output_filename_first_time = 0;
5097 num_source_filenames += 1;
5098 current_function_file = name;
5099 fprintf (stream, "\t.file\t%d ", num_source_filenames);
5100 output_quoted_string (stream, name);
5101 putc ('\n', stream);
5104 /* If we are emitting stabs, let dbxout.c handle this (except for
5105 the mips_output_filename_first_time case). */
5106 else if (write_symbols == DBX_DEBUG)
5107 return;
5109 else if (name != current_function_file
5110 && strcmp (name, current_function_file) != 0)
5112 num_source_filenames += 1;
5113 current_function_file = name;
5114 fprintf (stream, "\t.file\t%d ", num_source_filenames);
5115 output_quoted_string (stream, name);
5116 putc ('\n', stream);
5120 /* Output an ASCII string, in a space-saving way. PREFIX is the string
5121 that should be written before the opening quote, such as "\t.ascii\t"
5122 for real string data or "\t# " for a comment. */
5124 void
5125 mips_output_ascii (FILE *stream, const char *string_param, size_t len,
5126 const char *prefix)
5128 size_t i;
5129 int cur_pos = 17;
5130 register const unsigned char *string =
5131 (const unsigned char *)string_param;
5133 fprintf (stream, "%s\"", prefix);
5134 for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
5136 register int c = string[i];
5138 if (ISPRINT (c))
5140 if (c == '\\' || c == '\"')
5142 putc ('\\', stream);
5143 cur_pos++;
5145 putc (c, stream);
5146 cur_pos++;
5148 else
5150 fprintf (stream, "\\%03o", c);
5151 cur_pos += 4;
5154 if (cur_pos > 72 && i+1 < len)
5156 cur_pos = 17;
5157 fprintf (stream, "\"\n%s\"", prefix);
5160 fprintf (stream, "\"\n");
5163 /* Implement TARGET_ASM_FILE_START. */
5165 static void
5166 mips_file_start (void)
5168 default_file_start ();
5170 if (!TARGET_IRIX)
5172 /* Generate a special section to describe the ABI switches used to
5173 produce the resultant binary. This used to be done by the assembler
5174 setting bits in the ELF header's flags field, but we have run out of
5175 bits. GDB needs this information in order to be able to correctly
5176 debug these binaries. See the function mips_gdbarch_init() in
5177 gdb/mips-tdep.c. This is unnecessary for the IRIX 5/6 ABIs and
5178 causes unnecessary IRIX 6 ld warnings. */
5179 const char * abi_string = NULL;
5181 switch (mips_abi)
5183 case ABI_32: abi_string = "abi32"; break;
5184 case ABI_N32: abi_string = "abiN32"; break;
5185 case ABI_64: abi_string = "abi64"; break;
5186 case ABI_O64: abi_string = "abiO64"; break;
5187 case ABI_EABI: abi_string = TARGET_64BIT ? "eabi64" : "eabi32"; break;
5188 default:
5189 gcc_unreachable ();
5191 /* Note - we use fprintf directly rather than called named_section()
5192 because in this way we can avoid creating an allocated section. We
5193 do not want this section to take up any space in the running
5194 executable. */
5195 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.section .mdebug.%s\n", abi_string);
5197 /* There is no ELF header flag to distinguish long32 forms of the
5198 EABI from long64 forms. Emit a special section to help tools
5199 such as GDB. */
5200 if (mips_abi == ABI_EABI)
5201 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.section .gcc_compiled_long%d\n",
5202 TARGET_LONG64 ? 64 : 32);
5204 /* Restore the default section. */
5205 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.previous\n");
5208 /* Generate the pseudo ops that System V.4 wants. */
5209 if (TARGET_ABICALLS)
5210 /* ??? but do not want this (or want pic0) if -non-shared? */
5211 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.abicalls\n");
5213 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
5214 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.set\tmips16\n");
5216 if (flag_verbose_asm)
5217 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\n%s -G value = %d, Arch = %s, ISA = %d\n",
5218 ASM_COMMENT_START,
5219 mips_section_threshold, mips_arch_info->name, mips_isa);
5222 #ifdef BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5223 /* Implement ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS. This differs from the default only
5224 in the use of sbss. */
5226 void
5227 mips_output_aligned_bss (FILE *stream, tree decl, const char *name,
5228 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT size, int align)
5230 extern tree last_assemble_variable_decl;
5232 if (mips_in_small_data_p (decl))
5233 named_section (0, ".sbss", 0);
5234 else
5235 bss_section ();
5236 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (stream, floor_log2 (align / BITS_PER_UNIT));
5237 last_assemble_variable_decl = decl;
5238 ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (stream, name, decl);
5239 ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (stream, size != 0 ? size : 1);
5241 #endif
5243 /* Implement TARGET_ASM_FILE_END. When using assembler macros, emit
5244 .externs for any small-data variables that turned out to be external. */
5246 static void
5247 mips_file_end (void)
5249 tree name_tree;
5250 struct extern_list *p;
5252 if (extern_head)
5254 fputs ("\n", asm_out_file);
5256 for (p = extern_head; p != 0; p = p->next)
5258 name_tree = get_identifier (p->name);
5260 /* Positively ensure only one .extern for any given symbol. */
5261 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (name_tree)
5262 && TREE_SYMBOL_REFERENCED (name_tree))
5264 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (name_tree) = 1;
5265 /* In IRIX 5 or IRIX 6 for the O32 ABI, we must output a
5266 `.global name .text' directive for every used but
5267 undefined function. If we don't, the linker may perform
5268 an optimization (skipping over the insns that set $gp)
5269 when it is unsafe. */
5270 if (TARGET_IRIX && mips_abi == ABI_32 && p->size == -1)
5272 fputs ("\t.globl ", asm_out_file);
5273 assemble_name (asm_out_file, p->name);
5274 fputs (" .text\n", asm_out_file);
5276 else
5278 fputs ("\t.extern\t", asm_out_file);
5279 assemble_name (asm_out_file, p->name);
5280 fprintf (asm_out_file, ", %d\n", p->size);
5287 /* Implement ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON. This is usually the same as the
5288 elfos.h version, but we also need to handle -muninit-const-in-rodata. */
5290 void
5291 mips_output_aligned_decl_common (FILE *stream, tree decl, const char *name,
5292 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT size,
5293 unsigned int align)
5295 /* If the target wants uninitialized const declarations in
5296 .rdata then don't put them in .comm. */
5297 if (TARGET_EMBEDDED_DATA && TARGET_UNINIT_CONST_IN_RODATA
5298 && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && TREE_READONLY (decl)
5299 && (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == 0 || DECL_INITIAL (decl) == error_mark_node))
5301 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl) && DECL_NAME (decl))
5302 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (stream, name);
5304 readonly_data_section ();
5305 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (stream, floor_log2 (align / BITS_PER_UNIT));
5306 mips_declare_object (stream, name, "",
5307 ":\n\t.space\t" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED "\n",
5308 size);
5310 else
5311 mips_declare_common_object (stream, name, "\n\t.comm\t",
5312 size, align, true);
5315 /* Declare a common object of SIZE bytes using asm directive INIT_STRING.
5316 NAME is the name of the object and ALIGN is the required alignment
5317 in bytes. TAKES_ALIGNMENT_P is true if the directive takes a third
5318 alignment argument. */
5320 void
5321 mips_declare_common_object (FILE *stream, const char *name,
5322 const char *init_string,
5323 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT size,
5324 unsigned int align, bool takes_alignment_p)
5326 if (!takes_alignment_p)
5328 size += (align / BITS_PER_UNIT) - 1;
5329 size -= size % (align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
5330 mips_declare_object (stream, name, init_string,
5331 "," HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED "\n", size);
5333 else
5334 mips_declare_object (stream, name, init_string,
5335 "," HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED ",%u\n",
5336 size, align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
5339 /* Emit either a label, .comm, or .lcomm directive. When using assembler
5340 macros, mark the symbol as written so that mips_file_end won't emit an
5341 .extern for it. STREAM is the output file, NAME is the name of the
5342 symbol, INIT_STRING is the string that should be written before the
5343 symbol and FINAL_STRING is the string that should be written after it.
5344 FINAL_STRING is a printf() format that consumes the remaining arguments. */
5346 void
5347 mips_declare_object (FILE *stream, const char *name, const char *init_string,
5348 const char *final_string, ...)
5350 va_list ap;
5352 fputs (init_string, stream);
5353 assemble_name (stream, name);
5354 va_start (ap, final_string);
5355 vfprintf (stream, final_string, ap);
5356 va_end (ap);
5358 if (!TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS)
5360 tree name_tree = get_identifier (name);
5361 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (name_tree) = 1;
5365 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE
5366 extern int size_directive_output;
5368 /* Implement ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME. This is like most of the standard ELF
5369 definitions except that it uses mips_declare_object() to emit the label. */
5371 void
5372 mips_declare_object_name (FILE *stream, const char *name,
5373 tree decl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5375 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE
5376 ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (stream, name, "object");
5377 #endif
5379 size_directive_output = 0;
5380 if (!flag_inhibit_size_directive && DECL_SIZE (decl))
5382 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
5384 size_directive_output = 1;
5385 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (decl));
5386 ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (stream, name, size);
5389 mips_declare_object (stream, name, "", ":\n", 0);
5392 /* Implement ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT. This is generic ELF stuff. */
5394 void
5395 mips_finish_declare_object (FILE *stream, tree decl, int top_level, int at_end)
5397 const char *name;
5399 name = XSTR (XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0), 0);
5400 if (!flag_inhibit_size_directive
5401 && DECL_SIZE (decl) != 0
5402 && !at_end && top_level
5403 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) == error_mark_node
5404 && !size_directive_output)
5406 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
5408 size_directive_output = 1;
5409 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (decl));
5410 ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (stream, name, size);
5413 #endif
5415 /* Return true if X is a small data address that can be rewritten
5416 as a LO_SUM. */
5418 static bool
5419 mips_rewrite_small_data_p (rtx x)
5421 enum mips_symbol_type symbol_type;
5423 return (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS
5424 && mips_symbolic_constant_p (x, &symbol_type)
5425 && symbol_type == SYMBOL_SMALL_DATA);
5429 /* A for_each_rtx callback for mips_small_data_pattern_p. */
5431 static int
5432 mips_small_data_pattern_1 (rtx *loc, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5434 if (GET_CODE (*loc) == LO_SUM)
5435 return -1;
5437 return mips_rewrite_small_data_p (*loc);
5440 /* Return true if OP refers to small data symbols directly, not through
5441 a LO_SUM. */
5443 bool
5444 mips_small_data_pattern_p (rtx op)
5446 return for_each_rtx (&op, mips_small_data_pattern_1, 0);
5449 /* A for_each_rtx callback, used by mips_rewrite_small_data. */
5451 static int
5452 mips_rewrite_small_data_1 (rtx *loc, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5454 if (mips_rewrite_small_data_p (*loc))
5455 *loc = gen_rtx_LO_SUM (Pmode, pic_offset_table_rtx, *loc);
5457 if (GET_CODE (*loc) == LO_SUM)
5458 return -1;
5460 return 0;
5463 /* If possible, rewrite OP so that it refers to small data using
5464 explicit relocations. */
5467 mips_rewrite_small_data (rtx op)
5469 op = copy_insn (op);
5470 for_each_rtx (&op, mips_rewrite_small_data_1, 0);
5471 return op;
5474 /* Return true if the current function has an insn that implicitly
5475 refers to $gp. */
5477 static bool
5478 mips_function_has_gp_insn (void)
5480 /* Don't bother rechecking if we found one last time. */
5481 if (!cfun->machine->has_gp_insn_p)
5483 rtx insn;
5485 push_topmost_sequence ();
5486 for (insn = get_insns (); insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
5487 if (INSN_P (insn)
5488 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != USE
5489 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != CLOBBER
5490 && (get_attr_got (insn) != GOT_UNSET
5491 || small_data_pattern (PATTERN (insn), VOIDmode)))
5492 break;
5493 pop_topmost_sequence ();
5495 cfun->machine->has_gp_insn_p = (insn != 0);
5497 return cfun->machine->has_gp_insn_p;
5501 /* Return the register that should be used as the global pointer
5502 within this function. Return 0 if the function doesn't need
5503 a global pointer. */
5505 static unsigned int
5506 mips_global_pointer (void)
5508 unsigned int regno;
5510 /* $gp is always available in non-abicalls code. */
5511 if (!TARGET_ABICALLS)
5512 return GLOBAL_POINTER_REGNUM;
5514 /* We must always provide $gp when it is used implicitly. */
5515 if (!TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS)
5516 return GLOBAL_POINTER_REGNUM;
5518 /* FUNCTION_PROFILER includes a jal macro, so we need to give it
5519 a valid gp. */
5520 if (current_function_profile)
5521 return GLOBAL_POINTER_REGNUM;
5523 /* If the function has a nonlocal goto, $gp must hold the correct
5524 global pointer for the target function. */
5525 if (current_function_has_nonlocal_goto)
5526 return GLOBAL_POINTER_REGNUM;
5528 /* If the gp is never referenced, there's no need to initialize it.
5529 Note that reload can sometimes introduce constant pool references
5530 into a function that otherwise didn't need them. For example,
5531 suppose we have an instruction like:
5533 (set (reg:DF R1) (float:DF (reg:SI R2)))
5535 If R2 turns out to be constant such as 1, the instruction may have a
5536 REG_EQUAL note saying that R1 == 1.0. Reload then has the option of
5537 using this constant if R2 doesn't get allocated to a register.
5539 In cases like these, reload will have added the constant to the pool
5540 but no instruction will yet refer to it. */
5541 if (!regs_ever_live[GLOBAL_POINTER_REGNUM]
5542 && !current_function_uses_const_pool
5543 && !mips_function_has_gp_insn ())
5544 return 0;
5546 /* We need a global pointer, but perhaps we can use a call-clobbered
5547 register instead of $gp. */
5548 if (TARGET_NEWABI && current_function_is_leaf)
5549 for (regno = GP_REG_FIRST; regno <= GP_REG_LAST; regno++)
5550 if (!regs_ever_live[regno]
5551 && call_used_regs[regno]
5552 && !fixed_regs[regno]
5553 && regno != PIC_FUNCTION_ADDR_REGNUM)
5554 return regno;
5556 return GLOBAL_POINTER_REGNUM;
5560 /* Return true if the current function must save REGNO. */
5562 static bool
5563 mips_save_reg_p (unsigned int regno)
5565 /* We only need to save $gp for NewABI PIC. */
5566 if (regno == GLOBAL_POINTER_REGNUM)
5567 return (TARGET_ABICALLS && TARGET_NEWABI
5568 && cfun->machine->global_pointer == regno);
5570 /* Check call-saved registers. */
5571 if (regs_ever_live[regno] && !call_used_regs[regno])
5572 return true;
5574 /* We need to save the old frame pointer before setting up a new one. */
5575 if (regno == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && frame_pointer_needed)
5576 return true;
5578 /* We need to save the incoming return address if it is ever clobbered
5579 within the function. */
5580 if (regno == GP_REG_FIRST + 31 && regs_ever_live[regno])
5581 return true;
5583 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
5585 tree return_type;
5587 return_type = DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl);
5589 /* $18 is a special case in mips16 code. It may be used to call
5590 a function which returns a floating point value, but it is
5591 marked in call_used_regs. */
5592 if (regno == GP_REG_FIRST + 18 && regs_ever_live[regno])
5593 return true;
5595 /* $31 is also a special case. It will be used to copy a return
5596 value into the floating point registers if the return value is
5597 floating point. */
5598 if (regno == GP_REG_FIRST + 31
5599 && mips16_hard_float
5600 && !aggregate_value_p (return_type, current_function_decl)
5601 && GET_MODE_CLASS (DECL_MODE (return_type)) == MODE_FLOAT
5602 && GET_MODE_SIZE (DECL_MODE (return_type)) <= UNITS_PER_FPVALUE)
5603 return true;
5606 return false;
5610 /* Return the bytes needed to compute the frame pointer from the current
5611 stack pointer. SIZE is the size (in bytes) of the local variables.
5613 Mips stack frames look like:
5615 Before call After call
5616 +-----------------------+ +-----------------------+
5617 high | | | |
5618 mem. | | | |
5619 | caller's temps. | | caller's temps. |
5620 | | | |
5621 +-----------------------+ +-----------------------+
5622 | | | |
5623 | arguments on stack. | | arguments on stack. |
5624 | | | |
5625 +-----------------------+ +-----------------------+
5626 | 4 words to save | | 4 words to save |
5627 | arguments passed | | arguments passed |
5628 | in registers, even | | in registers, even |
5629 SP->| if not passed. | VFP->| if not passed. |
5630 +-----------------------+ +-----------------------+
5632 | fp register save |
5634 +-----------------------+
5636 | gp register save |
5638 +-----------------------+
5640 | local variables |
5642 +-----------------------+
5644 | alloca allocations |
5646 +-----------------------+
5648 | GP save for V.4 abi |
5650 +-----------------------+
5652 | arguments on stack |
5654 +-----------------------+
5655 | 4 words to save |
5656 | arguments passed |
5657 | in registers, even |
5658 low SP->| if not passed. |
5659 memory +-----------------------+
5663 HOST_WIDE_INT
5664 compute_frame_size (HOST_WIDE_INT size)
5666 unsigned int regno;
5667 HOST_WIDE_INT total_size; /* # bytes that the entire frame takes up */
5668 HOST_WIDE_INT var_size; /* # bytes that variables take up */
5669 HOST_WIDE_INT args_size; /* # bytes that outgoing arguments take up */
5670 HOST_WIDE_INT cprestore_size; /* # bytes that the cprestore slot takes up */
5671 HOST_WIDE_INT gp_reg_rounded; /* # bytes needed to store gp after rounding */
5672 HOST_WIDE_INT gp_reg_size; /* # bytes needed to store gp regs */
5673 HOST_WIDE_INT fp_reg_size; /* # bytes needed to store fp regs */
5674 unsigned int mask; /* mask of saved gp registers */
5675 unsigned int fmask; /* mask of saved fp registers */
5677 cfun->machine->global_pointer = mips_global_pointer ();
5679 gp_reg_size = 0;
5680 fp_reg_size = 0;
5681 mask = 0;
5682 fmask = 0;
5683 var_size = MIPS_STACK_ALIGN (size);
5684 args_size = current_function_outgoing_args_size;
5685 cprestore_size = MIPS_STACK_ALIGN (STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET) - args_size;
5687 /* The space set aside by STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET isn't needed in leaf
5688 functions. If the function has local variables, we're committed
5689 to allocating it anyway. Otherwise reclaim it here. */
5690 if (var_size == 0 && current_function_is_leaf)
5691 cprestore_size = args_size = 0;
5693 /* The MIPS 3.0 linker does not like functions that dynamically
5694 allocate the stack and have 0 for STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET, since it
5695 looks like we are trying to create a second frame pointer to the
5696 function, so allocate some stack space to make it happy. */
5698 if (args_size == 0 && current_function_calls_alloca)
5699 args_size = 4 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
5701 total_size = var_size + args_size + cprestore_size;
5703 /* Calculate space needed for gp registers. */
5704 for (regno = GP_REG_FIRST; regno <= GP_REG_LAST; regno++)
5705 if (mips_save_reg_p (regno))
5707 gp_reg_size += GET_MODE_SIZE (gpr_mode);
5708 mask |= 1 << (regno - GP_REG_FIRST);
5711 /* We need to restore these for the handler. */
5712 if (current_function_calls_eh_return)
5714 unsigned int i;
5715 for (i = 0; ; ++i)
5717 regno = EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (i);
5718 if (regno == INVALID_REGNUM)
5719 break;
5720 gp_reg_size += GET_MODE_SIZE (gpr_mode);
5721 mask |= 1 << (regno - GP_REG_FIRST);
5725 /* This loop must iterate over the same space as its companion in
5726 save_restore_insns. */
5727 for (regno = (FP_REG_LAST - FP_INC + 1);
5728 regno >= FP_REG_FIRST;
5729 regno -= FP_INC)
5731 if (mips_save_reg_p (regno))
5733 fp_reg_size += FP_INC * UNITS_PER_FPREG;
5734 fmask |= ((1 << FP_INC) - 1) << (regno - FP_REG_FIRST);
5738 gp_reg_rounded = MIPS_STACK_ALIGN (gp_reg_size);
5739 total_size += gp_reg_rounded + MIPS_STACK_ALIGN (fp_reg_size);
5741 /* Add in space reserved on the stack by the callee for storing arguments
5742 passed in registers. */
5743 if (!TARGET_OLDABI)
5744 total_size += MIPS_STACK_ALIGN (current_function_pretend_args_size);
5746 /* Save other computed information. */
5747 cfun->machine->frame.total_size = total_size;
5748 cfun->machine->frame.var_size = var_size;
5749 cfun->machine->frame.args_size = args_size;
5750 cfun->machine->frame.cprestore_size = cprestore_size;
5751 cfun->machine->frame.gp_reg_size = gp_reg_size;
5752 cfun->machine->frame.fp_reg_size = fp_reg_size;
5753 cfun->machine->frame.mask = mask;
5754 cfun->machine->frame.fmask = fmask;
5755 cfun->machine->frame.initialized = reload_completed;
5756 cfun->machine->frame.num_gp = gp_reg_size / UNITS_PER_WORD;
5757 cfun->machine->frame.num_fp = fp_reg_size / (FP_INC * UNITS_PER_FPREG);
5759 if (mask)
5761 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
5763 offset = (args_size + cprestore_size + var_size
5764 + gp_reg_size - GET_MODE_SIZE (gpr_mode));
5765 cfun->machine->frame.gp_sp_offset = offset;
5766 cfun->machine->frame.gp_save_offset = offset - total_size;
5768 else
5770 cfun->machine->frame.gp_sp_offset = 0;
5771 cfun->machine->frame.gp_save_offset = 0;
5774 if (fmask)
5776 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
5778 offset = (args_size + cprestore_size + var_size
5779 + gp_reg_rounded + fp_reg_size
5780 - FP_INC * UNITS_PER_FPREG);
5781 cfun->machine->frame.fp_sp_offset = offset;
5782 cfun->machine->frame.fp_save_offset = offset - total_size;
5784 else
5786 cfun->machine->frame.fp_sp_offset = 0;
5787 cfun->machine->frame.fp_save_offset = 0;
5790 /* Ok, we're done. */
5791 return total_size;
5794 /* Implement INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET. FROM is either the frame
5795 pointer or argument pointer. TO is either the stack pointer or
5796 hard frame pointer. */
5798 HOST_WIDE_INT
5799 mips_initial_elimination_offset (int from, int to)
5801 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
5803 compute_frame_size (get_frame_size ());
5805 /* Set OFFSET to the offset from the stack pointer. */
5806 switch (from)
5808 case FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM:
5809 offset = 0;
5810 break;
5812 case ARG_POINTER_REGNUM:
5813 offset = cfun->machine->frame.total_size;
5814 if (TARGET_NEWABI)
5815 offset -= current_function_pretend_args_size;
5816 break;
5818 default:
5819 gcc_unreachable ();
5822 if (TARGET_MIPS16 && to == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
5823 offset -= cfun->machine->frame.args_size;
5825 return offset;
5828 /* Implement RETURN_ADDR_RTX. Note, we do not support moving
5829 back to a previous frame. */
5831 mips_return_addr (int count, rtx frame ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5833 if (count != 0)
5834 return const0_rtx;
5836 return get_hard_reg_initial_val (Pmode, GP_REG_FIRST + 31);
5839 /* Use FN to save or restore register REGNO. MODE is the register's
5840 mode and OFFSET is the offset of its save slot from the current
5841 stack pointer. */
5843 static void
5844 mips_save_restore_reg (enum machine_mode mode, int regno,
5845 HOST_WIDE_INT offset, mips_save_restore_fn fn)
5847 rtx mem;
5849 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx, offset));
5851 fn (gen_rtx_REG (mode, regno), mem);
5855 /* Call FN for each register that is saved by the current function.
5856 SP_OFFSET is the offset of the current stack pointer from the start
5857 of the frame. */
5859 static void
5860 mips_for_each_saved_reg (HOST_WIDE_INT sp_offset, mips_save_restore_fn fn)
5862 #define BITSET_P(VALUE, BIT) (((VALUE) & (1L << (BIT))) != 0)
5864 enum machine_mode fpr_mode;
5865 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
5866 int regno;
5868 /* Save registers starting from high to low. The debuggers prefer at least
5869 the return register be stored at func+4, and also it allows us not to
5870 need a nop in the epilog if at least one register is reloaded in
5871 addition to return address. */
5872 offset = cfun->machine->frame.gp_sp_offset - sp_offset;
5873 for (regno = GP_REG_LAST; regno >= GP_REG_FIRST; regno--)
5874 if (BITSET_P (cfun->machine->frame.mask, regno - GP_REG_FIRST))
5876 mips_save_restore_reg (gpr_mode, regno, offset, fn);
5877 offset -= GET_MODE_SIZE (gpr_mode);
5880 /* This loop must iterate over the same space as its companion in
5881 compute_frame_size. */
5882 offset = cfun->machine->frame.fp_sp_offset - sp_offset;
5883 fpr_mode = (TARGET_SINGLE_FLOAT ? SFmode : DFmode);
5884 for (regno = (FP_REG_LAST - FP_INC + 1);
5885 regno >= FP_REG_FIRST;
5886 regno -= FP_INC)
5887 if (BITSET_P (cfun->machine->frame.fmask, regno - FP_REG_FIRST))
5889 mips_save_restore_reg (fpr_mode, regno, offset, fn);
5890 offset -= GET_MODE_SIZE (fpr_mode);
5892 #undef BITSET_P
5895 /* If we're generating n32 or n64 abicalls, and the current function
5896 does not use $28 as its global pointer, emit a cplocal directive.
5897 Use pic_offset_table_rtx as the argument to the directive. */
5899 static void
5900 mips_output_cplocal (void)
5902 if (!TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS
5903 && cfun->machine->global_pointer > 0
5904 && cfun->machine->global_pointer != GLOBAL_POINTER_REGNUM)
5905 output_asm_insn (".cplocal %+", 0);
5908 /* If we're generating n32 or n64 abicalls, emit instructions
5909 to set up the global pointer. */
5911 static void
5912 mips_emit_loadgp (void)
5914 if (TARGET_ABICALLS && TARGET_NEWABI && cfun->machine->global_pointer > 0)
5916 rtx addr, offset, incoming_address;
5918 addr = XEXP (DECL_RTL (current_function_decl), 0);
5919 offset = mips_unspec_address (addr, SYMBOL_GOTOFF_LOADGP);
5920 incoming_address = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, PIC_FUNCTION_ADDR_REGNUM);
5921 emit_insn (gen_loadgp (offset, incoming_address));
5922 if (!TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS)
5923 emit_insn (gen_loadgp_blockage ());
5927 /* Set up the stack and frame (if desired) for the function. */
5929 static void
5930 mips_output_function_prologue (FILE *file, HOST_WIDE_INT size ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5932 const char *fnname;
5933 HOST_WIDE_INT tsize = cfun->machine->frame.total_size;
5935 #ifdef SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
5936 if (debug_info_level != DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE && write_symbols == SDB_DEBUG)
5937 SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (file, DECL_SOURCE_LINE (current_function_decl));
5938 #endif
5940 /* In mips16 mode, we may need to generate a 32 bit to handle
5941 floating point arguments. The linker will arrange for any 32 bit
5942 functions to call this stub, which will then jump to the 16 bit
5943 function proper. */
5944 if (TARGET_MIPS16 && !TARGET_SOFT_FLOAT
5945 && current_function_args_info.fp_code != 0)
5946 build_mips16_function_stub (file);
5948 if (!FUNCTION_NAME_ALREADY_DECLARED)
5950 /* Get the function name the same way that toplev.c does before calling
5951 assemble_start_function. This is needed so that the name used here
5952 exactly matches the name used in ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME. */
5953 fnname = XSTR (XEXP (DECL_RTL (current_function_decl), 0), 0);
5955 if (!flag_inhibit_size_directive)
5957 fputs ("\t.ent\t", file);
5958 assemble_name (file, fnname);
5959 fputs ("\n", file);
5962 assemble_name (file, fnname);
5963 fputs (":\n", file);
5966 /* Stop mips_file_end from treating this function as external. */
5967 if (TARGET_IRIX && mips_abi == ABI_32)
5968 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (DECL_NAME (cfun->decl)) = 1;
5970 if (!flag_inhibit_size_directive)
5972 /* .frame FRAMEREG, FRAMESIZE, RETREG */
5973 fprintf (file,
5974 "\t.frame\t%s," HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC ",%s\t\t"
5975 "# vars= " HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC ", regs= %d/%d"
5976 ", args= " HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC
5977 ", gp= " HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "\n",
5978 (reg_names[(frame_pointer_needed)
5979 ? HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM : STACK_POINTER_REGNUM]),
5980 ((frame_pointer_needed && TARGET_MIPS16)
5981 ? tsize - cfun->machine->frame.args_size
5982 : tsize),
5983 reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST + 31],
5984 cfun->machine->frame.var_size,
5985 cfun->machine->frame.num_gp,
5986 cfun->machine->frame.num_fp,
5987 cfun->machine->frame.args_size,
5988 cfun->machine->frame.cprestore_size);
5990 /* .mask MASK, GPOFFSET; .fmask FPOFFSET */
5991 fprintf (file, "\t.mask\t0x%08x," HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "\n",
5992 cfun->machine->frame.mask,
5993 cfun->machine->frame.gp_save_offset);
5994 fprintf (file, "\t.fmask\t0x%08x," HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "\n",
5995 cfun->machine->frame.fmask,
5996 cfun->machine->frame.fp_save_offset);
5998 /* Require:
5999 OLD_SP == *FRAMEREG + FRAMESIZE => can find old_sp from nominated FP reg.
6000 HIGHEST_GP_SAVED == *FRAMEREG + FRAMESIZE + GPOFFSET => can find saved regs. */
6003 if (TARGET_ABICALLS && !TARGET_NEWABI && cfun->machine->global_pointer > 0)
6005 /* Handle the initialization of $gp for SVR4 PIC. */
6006 if (!cfun->machine->all_noreorder_p)
6007 output_asm_insn ("%(.cpload\t%^%)", 0);
6008 else
6009 output_asm_insn ("%(.cpload\t%^\n\t%<", 0);
6011 else if (cfun->machine->all_noreorder_p)
6012 output_asm_insn ("%(%<", 0);
6014 /* Tell the assembler which register we're using as the global
6015 pointer. This is needed for thunks, since they can use either
6016 explicit relocs or assembler macros. */
6017 mips_output_cplocal ();
6020 /* Make the last instruction frame related and note that it performs
6021 the operation described by FRAME_PATTERN. */
6023 static void
6024 mips_set_frame_expr (rtx frame_pattern)
6026 rtx insn;
6028 insn = get_last_insn ();
6029 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
6030 REG_NOTES (insn) = alloc_EXPR_LIST (REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR,
6031 frame_pattern,
6032 REG_NOTES (insn));
6036 /* Return a frame-related rtx that stores REG at MEM.
6037 REG must be a single register. */
6039 static rtx
6040 mips_frame_set (rtx mem, rtx reg)
6042 rtx set = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, mem, reg);
6043 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (set) = 1;
6044 return set;
6048 /* Save register REG to MEM. Make the instruction frame-related. */
6050 static void
6051 mips_save_reg (rtx reg, rtx mem)
6053 if (GET_MODE (reg) == DFmode && !TARGET_FLOAT64)
6055 rtx x1, x2;
6057 if (mips_split_64bit_move_p (mem, reg))
6058 mips_split_64bit_move (mem, reg);
6059 else
6060 emit_move_insn (mem, reg);
6062 x1 = mips_frame_set (mips_subword (mem, 0), mips_subword (reg, 0));
6063 x2 = mips_frame_set (mips_subword (mem, 1), mips_subword (reg, 1));
6064 mips_set_frame_expr (gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode, gen_rtvec (2, x1, x2)));
6066 else
6068 if (TARGET_MIPS16
6069 && REGNO (reg) != GP_REG_FIRST + 31
6070 && !M16_REG_P (REGNO (reg)))
6072 /* Save a non-mips16 register by moving it through a temporary.
6073 We don't need to do this for $31 since there's a special
6074 instruction for it. */
6075 emit_move_insn (MIPS_PROLOGUE_TEMP (GET_MODE (reg)), reg);
6076 emit_move_insn (mem, MIPS_PROLOGUE_TEMP (GET_MODE (reg)));
6078 else
6079 emit_move_insn (mem, reg);
6081 mips_set_frame_expr (mips_frame_set (mem, reg));
6086 /* Expand the prologue into a bunch of separate insns. */
6088 void
6089 mips_expand_prologue (void)
6091 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
6093 if (cfun->machine->global_pointer > 0)
6094 REGNO (pic_offset_table_rtx) = cfun->machine->global_pointer;
6096 size = compute_frame_size (get_frame_size ());
6098 /* Save the registers. Allocate up to MIPS_MAX_FIRST_STACK_STEP
6099 bytes beforehand; this is enough to cover the register save area
6100 without going out of range. */
6101 if ((cfun->machine->frame.mask | cfun->machine->frame.fmask) != 0)
6103 HOST_WIDE_INT step1;
6105 step1 = MIN (size, MIPS_MAX_FIRST_STACK_STEP);
6106 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (emit_insn (gen_add3_insn (stack_pointer_rtx,
6107 stack_pointer_rtx,
6108 GEN_INT (-step1)))) = 1;
6109 size -= step1;
6110 mips_for_each_saved_reg (size, mips_save_reg);
6113 /* Allocate the rest of the frame. */
6114 if (size > 0)
6116 if (SMALL_OPERAND (-size))
6117 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (emit_insn (gen_add3_insn (stack_pointer_rtx,
6118 stack_pointer_rtx,
6119 GEN_INT (-size)))) = 1;
6120 else
6122 emit_move_insn (MIPS_PROLOGUE_TEMP (Pmode), GEN_INT (size));
6123 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
6125 /* There are no instructions to add or subtract registers
6126 from the stack pointer, so use the frame pointer as a
6127 temporary. We should always be using a frame pointer
6128 in this case anyway. */
6129 gcc_assert (frame_pointer_needed);
6130 emit_move_insn (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx);
6131 emit_insn (gen_sub3_insn (hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
6132 hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
6133 MIPS_PROLOGUE_TEMP (Pmode)));
6134 emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx, hard_frame_pointer_rtx);
6136 else
6137 emit_insn (gen_sub3_insn (stack_pointer_rtx,
6138 stack_pointer_rtx,
6139 MIPS_PROLOGUE_TEMP (Pmode)));
6141 /* Describe the combined effect of the previous instructions. */
6142 mips_set_frame_expr
6143 (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
6144 plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx, -size)));
6148 /* Set up the frame pointer, if we're using one. In mips16 code,
6149 we point the frame pointer ahead of the outgoing argument area.
6150 This should allow more variables & incoming arguments to be
6151 accessed with unextended instructions. */
6152 if (frame_pointer_needed)
6154 if (TARGET_MIPS16 && cfun->machine->frame.args_size != 0)
6156 rtx offset = GEN_INT (cfun->machine->frame.args_size);
6157 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P
6158 (emit_insn (gen_add3_insn (hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
6159 stack_pointer_rtx,
6160 offset))) = 1;
6162 else
6163 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (emit_move_insn (hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
6164 stack_pointer_rtx)) = 1;
6167 /* If generating o32/o64 abicalls, save $gp on the stack. */
6168 if (TARGET_ABICALLS && !TARGET_NEWABI && !current_function_is_leaf)
6169 emit_insn (gen_cprestore (GEN_INT (current_function_outgoing_args_size)));
6171 mips_emit_loadgp ();
6173 /* If we are profiling, make sure no instructions are scheduled before
6174 the call to mcount. */
6176 if (current_function_profile)
6177 emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
6180 /* Do any necessary cleanup after a function to restore stack, frame,
6181 and regs. */
6183 #define RA_MASK BITMASK_HIGH /* 1 << 31 */
6185 static void
6186 mips_output_function_epilogue (FILE *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6187 HOST_WIDE_INT size ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6189 /* Reinstate the normal $gp. */
6190 REGNO (pic_offset_table_rtx) = GLOBAL_POINTER_REGNUM;
6191 mips_output_cplocal ();
6193 if (cfun->machine->all_noreorder_p)
6195 /* Avoid using %>%) since it adds excess whitespace. */
6196 output_asm_insn (".set\tmacro", 0);
6197 output_asm_insn (".set\treorder", 0);
6198 set_noreorder = set_nomacro = 0;
6201 if (!FUNCTION_NAME_ALREADY_DECLARED && !flag_inhibit_size_directive)
6203 const char *fnname;
6205 /* Get the function name the same way that toplev.c does before calling
6206 assemble_start_function. This is needed so that the name used here
6207 exactly matches the name used in ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME. */
6208 fnname = XSTR (XEXP (DECL_RTL (current_function_decl), 0), 0);
6209 fputs ("\t.end\t", file);
6210 assemble_name (file, fnname);
6211 fputs ("\n", file);
6215 /* Emit instructions to restore register REG from slot MEM. */
6217 static void
6218 mips_restore_reg (rtx reg, rtx mem)
6220 /* There's no mips16 instruction to load $31 directly. Load into
6221 $7 instead and adjust the return insn appropriately. */
6222 if (TARGET_MIPS16 && REGNO (reg) == GP_REG_FIRST + 31)
6223 reg = gen_rtx_REG (GET_MODE (reg), 7);
6225 if (TARGET_MIPS16 && !M16_REG_P (REGNO (reg)))
6227 /* Can't restore directly; move through a temporary. */
6228 emit_move_insn (MIPS_EPILOGUE_TEMP (GET_MODE (reg)), mem);
6229 emit_move_insn (reg, MIPS_EPILOGUE_TEMP (GET_MODE (reg)));
6231 else
6232 emit_move_insn (reg, mem);
6236 /* Expand the epilogue into a bunch of separate insns. SIBCALL_P is true
6237 if this epilogue precedes a sibling call, false if it is for a normal
6238 "epilogue" pattern. */
6240 void
6241 mips_expand_epilogue (int sibcall_p)
6243 HOST_WIDE_INT step1, step2;
6244 rtx base, target;
6246 if (!sibcall_p && mips_can_use_return_insn ())
6248 emit_jump_insn (gen_return ());
6249 return;
6252 /* Split the frame into two. STEP1 is the amount of stack we should
6253 deallocate before restoring the registers. STEP2 is the amount we
6254 should deallocate afterwards.
6256 Start off by assuming that no registers need to be restored. */
6257 step1 = cfun->machine->frame.total_size;
6258 step2 = 0;
6260 /* Work out which register holds the frame address. Account for the
6261 frame pointer offset used by mips16 code. */
6262 if (!frame_pointer_needed)
6263 base = stack_pointer_rtx;
6264 else
6266 base = hard_frame_pointer_rtx;
6267 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
6268 step1 -= cfun->machine->frame.args_size;
6271 /* If we need to restore registers, deallocate as much stack as
6272 possible in the second step without going out of range. */
6273 if ((cfun->machine->frame.mask | cfun->machine->frame.fmask) != 0)
6275 step2 = MIN (step1, MIPS_MAX_FIRST_STACK_STEP);
6276 step1 -= step2;
6279 /* Set TARGET to BASE + STEP1. */
6280 target = base;
6281 if (step1 > 0)
6283 rtx adjust;
6285 /* Get an rtx for STEP1 that we can add to BASE. */
6286 adjust = GEN_INT (step1);
6287 if (!SMALL_OPERAND (step1))
6289 emit_move_insn (MIPS_EPILOGUE_TEMP (Pmode), adjust);
6290 adjust = MIPS_EPILOGUE_TEMP (Pmode);
6293 /* Normal mode code can copy the result straight into $sp. */
6294 if (!TARGET_MIPS16)
6295 target = stack_pointer_rtx;
6297 emit_insn (gen_add3_insn (target, base, adjust));
6300 /* Copy TARGET into the stack pointer. */
6301 if (target != stack_pointer_rtx)
6302 emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx, target);
6304 /* If we're using addressing macros for n32/n64 abicalls, $gp is
6305 implicitly used by all SYMBOL_REFs. We must emit a blockage
6306 insn before restoring it. */
6307 if (TARGET_ABICALLS && TARGET_NEWABI && !TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS)
6308 emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
6310 /* Restore the registers. */
6311 mips_for_each_saved_reg (cfun->machine->frame.total_size - step2,
6312 mips_restore_reg);
6314 /* Deallocate the final bit of the frame. */
6315 if (step2 > 0)
6316 emit_insn (gen_add3_insn (stack_pointer_rtx,
6317 stack_pointer_rtx,
6318 GEN_INT (step2)));
6320 /* Add in the __builtin_eh_return stack adjustment. We need to
6321 use a temporary in mips16 code. */
6322 if (current_function_calls_eh_return)
6324 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
6326 emit_move_insn (MIPS_EPILOGUE_TEMP (Pmode), stack_pointer_rtx);
6327 emit_insn (gen_add3_insn (MIPS_EPILOGUE_TEMP (Pmode),
6328 MIPS_EPILOGUE_TEMP (Pmode),
6329 EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX));
6330 emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx, MIPS_EPILOGUE_TEMP (Pmode));
6332 else
6333 emit_insn (gen_add3_insn (stack_pointer_rtx,
6334 stack_pointer_rtx,
6335 EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX));
6338 if (!sibcall_p)
6340 /* The mips16 loads the return address into $7, not $31. */
6341 if (TARGET_MIPS16 && (cfun->machine->frame.mask & RA_MASK) != 0)
6342 emit_jump_insn (gen_return_internal (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode,
6343 GP_REG_FIRST + 7)));
6344 else
6345 emit_jump_insn (gen_return_internal (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode,
6346 GP_REG_FIRST + 31)));
6350 /* Return nonzero if this function is known to have a null epilogue.
6351 This allows the optimizer to omit jumps to jumps if no stack
6352 was created. */
6355 mips_can_use_return_insn (void)
6357 tree return_type;
6359 if (! reload_completed)
6360 return 0;
6362 if (regs_ever_live[31] || current_function_profile)
6363 return 0;
6365 return_type = DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl);
6367 /* In mips16 mode, a function which returns a floating point value
6368 needs to arrange to copy the return value into the floating point
6369 registers. */
6370 if (TARGET_MIPS16
6371 && mips16_hard_float
6372 && ! aggregate_value_p (return_type, current_function_decl)
6373 && GET_MODE_CLASS (DECL_MODE (return_type)) == MODE_FLOAT
6374 && GET_MODE_SIZE (DECL_MODE (return_type)) <= UNITS_PER_FPVALUE)
6375 return 0;
6377 if (cfun->machine->frame.initialized)
6378 return cfun->machine->frame.total_size == 0;
6380 return compute_frame_size (get_frame_size ()) == 0;
6383 /* Implement TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK. Generate rtl rather than asm text
6384 in order to avoid duplicating too much logic from elsewhere. */
6386 static void
6387 mips_output_mi_thunk (FILE *file, tree thunk_fndecl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6388 HOST_WIDE_INT delta, HOST_WIDE_INT vcall_offset,
6389 tree function)
6391 rtx this, temp1, temp2, insn, fnaddr;
6393 /* Pretend to be a post-reload pass while generating rtl. */
6394 no_new_pseudos = 1;
6395 reload_completed = 1;
6396 reset_block_changes ();
6398 /* Pick a global pointer for -mabicalls. Use $15 rather than $28
6399 for TARGET_NEWABI since the latter is a call-saved register. */
6400 if (TARGET_ABICALLS)
6401 cfun->machine->global_pointer
6402 = REGNO (pic_offset_table_rtx)
6403 = TARGET_NEWABI ? 15 : GLOBAL_POINTER_REGNUM;
6405 /* Set up the global pointer for n32 or n64 abicalls. */
6406 mips_emit_loadgp ();
6408 /* We need two temporary registers in some cases. */
6409 temp1 = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 2);
6410 temp2 = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 3);
6412 /* Find out which register contains the "this" pointer. */
6413 if (aggregate_value_p (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (function)), function))
6414 this = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, GP_ARG_FIRST + 1);
6415 else
6416 this = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, GP_ARG_FIRST);
6418 /* Add DELTA to THIS. */
6419 if (delta != 0)
6421 rtx offset = GEN_INT (delta);
6422 if (!SMALL_OPERAND (delta))
6424 emit_move_insn (temp1, offset);
6425 offset = temp1;
6427 emit_insn (gen_add3_insn (this, this, offset));
6430 /* If needed, add *(*THIS + VCALL_OFFSET) to THIS. */
6431 if (vcall_offset != 0)
6433 rtx addr;
6435 /* Set TEMP1 to *THIS. */
6436 emit_move_insn (temp1, gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, this));
6438 /* Set ADDR to a legitimate address for *THIS + VCALL_OFFSET. */
6439 addr = mips_add_offset (temp2, temp1, vcall_offset);
6441 /* Load the offset and add it to THIS. */
6442 emit_move_insn (temp1, gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, addr));
6443 emit_insn (gen_add3_insn (this, this, temp1));
6446 /* Jump to the target function. Use a sibcall if direct jumps are
6447 allowed, otherwise load the address into a register first. */
6448 fnaddr = XEXP (DECL_RTL (function), 0);
6449 if (TARGET_MIPS16 || TARGET_ABICALLS || TARGET_LONG_CALLS)
6451 /* This is messy. gas treats "la $25,foo" as part of a call
6452 sequence and may allow a global "foo" to be lazily bound.
6453 The general move patterns therefore reject this combination.
6455 In this context, lazy binding would actually be OK for o32 and o64,
6456 but it's still wrong for n32 and n64; see mips_load_call_address.
6457 We must therefore load the address via a temporary register if
6458 mips_dangerous_for_la25_p.
6460 If we jump to the temporary register rather than $25, the assembler
6461 can use the move insn to fill the jump's delay slot. */
6462 if (TARGET_ABICALLS && !mips_dangerous_for_la25_p (fnaddr))
6463 temp1 = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, PIC_FUNCTION_ADDR_REGNUM);
6464 mips_load_call_address (temp1, fnaddr, true);
6466 if (TARGET_ABICALLS && REGNO (temp1) != PIC_FUNCTION_ADDR_REGNUM)
6467 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, PIC_FUNCTION_ADDR_REGNUM), temp1);
6468 emit_jump_insn (gen_indirect_jump (temp1));
6470 else
6472 insn = emit_call_insn (gen_sibcall_internal (fnaddr, const0_rtx));
6473 SIBLING_CALL_P (insn) = 1;
6476 /* Run just enough of rest_of_compilation. This sequence was
6477 "borrowed" from alpha.c. */
6478 insn = get_insns ();
6479 insn_locators_initialize ();
6480 split_all_insns_noflow ();
6481 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
6482 mips16_lay_out_constants ();
6483 shorten_branches (insn);
6484 final_start_function (insn, file, 1);
6485 final (insn, file, 1, 0);
6486 final_end_function ();
6488 /* Clean up the vars set above. Note that final_end_function resets
6489 the global pointer for us. */
6490 reload_completed = 0;
6491 no_new_pseudos = 0;
6494 /* Returns nonzero if X contains a SYMBOL_REF. */
6496 static int
6497 symbolic_expression_p (rtx x)
6499 if (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF)
6500 return 1;
6502 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST)
6503 return symbolic_expression_p (XEXP (x, 0));
6505 if (UNARY_P (x))
6506 return symbolic_expression_p (XEXP (x, 0));
6508 if (ARITHMETIC_P (x))
6509 return (symbolic_expression_p (XEXP (x, 0))
6510 || symbolic_expression_p (XEXP (x, 1)));
6512 return 0;
6515 /* Choose the section to use for the constant rtx expression X that has
6516 mode MODE. */
6518 static void
6519 mips_select_rtx_section (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x,
6520 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT align)
6522 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
6524 /* In mips16 mode, the constant table always goes in the same section
6525 as the function, so that constants can be loaded using PC relative
6526 addressing. */
6527 function_section (current_function_decl);
6529 else if (TARGET_EMBEDDED_DATA)
6531 /* For embedded applications, always put constants in read-only data,
6532 in order to reduce RAM usage. */
6533 mergeable_constant_section (mode, align, 0);
6535 else
6537 /* For hosted applications, always put constants in small data if
6538 possible, as this gives the best performance. */
6539 /* ??? Consider using mergeable small data sections. */
6541 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= (unsigned) mips_section_threshold
6542 && mips_section_threshold > 0)
6543 named_section (0, ".sdata", 0);
6544 else if (flag_pic && symbolic_expression_p (x))
6545 named_section (0, ".data.rel.ro", 3);
6546 else
6547 mergeable_constant_section (mode, align, 0);
6551 /* Implement TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION.
6553 The complication here is that, with the combination TARGET_ABICALLS
6554 && !TARGET_GPWORD, jump tables will use absolute addresses, and should
6555 therefore not be included in the read-only part of a DSO. Handle such
6556 cases by selecting a normal data section instead of a read-only one.
6557 The logic apes that in default_function_rodata_section. */
6559 static void
6560 mips_function_rodata_section (tree decl)
6562 if (!TARGET_ABICALLS || TARGET_GPWORD)
6563 default_function_rodata_section (decl);
6564 else if (decl && DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
6566 const char *name = TREE_STRING_POINTER (DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl));
6567 if (DECL_ONE_ONLY (decl) && strncmp (name, ".gnu.linkonce.t.", 16) == 0)
6569 char *rname = ASTRDUP (name);
6570 rname[14] = 'd';
6571 named_section_real (rname, SECTION_LINKONCE | SECTION_WRITE, decl);
6573 else if (flag_function_sections && flag_data_sections
6574 && strncmp (name, ".text.", 6) == 0)
6576 char *rname = ASTRDUP (name);
6577 memcpy (rname + 1, "data", 4);
6578 named_section_flags (rname, SECTION_WRITE);
6580 else
6581 data_section ();
6583 else
6584 data_section ();
6587 /* Implement TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P. Return true if it would be safe to
6588 access DECL using %gp_rel(...)($gp). */
6590 static bool
6591 mips_in_small_data_p (tree decl)
6593 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
6595 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == STRING_CST || TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
6596 return false;
6598 /* We don't yet generate small-data references for -mabicalls. See related
6599 -G handling in override_options. */
6600 if (TARGET_ABICALLS)
6601 return false;
6603 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl) != 0)
6605 const char *name;
6607 /* Reject anything that isn't in a known small-data section. */
6608 name = TREE_STRING_POINTER (DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl));
6609 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") != 0 && strcmp (name, ".sbss") != 0)
6610 return false;
6612 /* If a symbol is defined externally, the assembler will use the
6613 usual -G rules when deciding how to implement macros. */
6614 if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS || !DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
6615 return true;
6617 else if (TARGET_EMBEDDED_DATA)
6619 /* Don't put constants into the small data section: we want them
6620 to be in ROM rather than RAM. */
6621 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL)
6622 return false;
6624 if (TREE_READONLY (decl)
6625 && !TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (decl)
6626 && (!DECL_INITIAL (decl) || TREE_CONSTANT (DECL_INITIAL (decl))))
6627 return false;
6630 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (decl));
6631 return (size > 0 && size <= mips_section_threshold);
6634 /* See whether VALTYPE is a record whose fields should be returned in
6635 floating-point registers. If so, return the number of fields and
6636 list them in FIELDS (which should have two elements). Return 0
6637 otherwise.
6639 For n32 & n64, a structure with one or two fields is returned in
6640 floating-point registers as long as every field has a floating-point
6641 type. */
6643 static int
6644 mips_fpr_return_fields (tree valtype, tree *fields)
6646 tree field;
6647 int i;
6649 if (!TARGET_NEWABI)
6650 return 0;
6652 if (TREE_CODE (valtype) != RECORD_TYPE)
6653 return 0;
6655 i = 0;
6656 for (field = TYPE_FIELDS (valtype); field != 0; field = TREE_CHAIN (field))
6658 if (TREE_CODE (field) != FIELD_DECL)
6659 continue;
6661 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (field)) != REAL_TYPE)
6662 return 0;
6664 if (i == 2)
6665 return 0;
6667 fields[i++] = field;
6669 return i;
6673 /* Implement TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB. For n32 & n64, we should return
6674 a value in the most significant part of $2/$3 if:
6676 - the target is big-endian;
6678 - the value has a structure or union type (we generalize this to
6679 cover aggregates from other languages too); and
6681 - the structure is not returned in floating-point registers. */
6683 static bool
6684 mips_return_in_msb (tree valtype)
6686 tree fields[2];
6688 return (TARGET_NEWABI
6689 && TARGET_BIG_ENDIAN
6690 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (valtype)
6691 && mips_fpr_return_fields (valtype, fields) == 0);
6695 /* Return a composite value in a pair of floating-point registers.
6696 MODE1 and OFFSET1 are the mode and byte offset for the first value,
6697 likewise MODE2 and OFFSET2 for the second. MODE is the mode of the
6698 complete value.
6700 For n32 & n64, $f0 always holds the first value and $f2 the second.
6701 Otherwise the values are packed together as closely as possible. */
6703 static rtx
6704 mips_return_fpr_pair (enum machine_mode mode,
6705 enum machine_mode mode1, HOST_WIDE_INT offset1,
6706 enum machine_mode mode2, HOST_WIDE_INT offset2)
6708 int inc;
6710 inc = (TARGET_NEWABI ? 2 : FP_INC);
6711 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL
6712 (mode,
6713 gen_rtvec (2,
6714 gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode,
6715 gen_rtx_REG (mode1, FP_RETURN),
6716 GEN_INT (offset1)),
6717 gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode,
6718 gen_rtx_REG (mode2, FP_RETURN + inc),
6719 GEN_INT (offset2))));
6724 /* Implement FUNCTION_VALUE and LIBCALL_VALUE. For normal calls,
6725 VALTYPE is the return type and MODE is VOIDmode. For libcalls,
6726 VALTYPE is null and MODE is the mode of the return value. */
6729 mips_function_value (tree valtype, tree func ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6730 enum machine_mode mode)
6732 if (valtype)
6734 tree fields[2];
6735 int unsignedp;
6737 mode = TYPE_MODE (valtype);
6738 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (valtype);
6740 /* Since we define TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN that returns
6741 true, we must promote the mode just as PROMOTE_MODE does. */
6742 mode = promote_mode (valtype, mode, &unsignedp, 1);
6744 /* Handle structures whose fields are returned in $f0/$f2. */
6745 switch (mips_fpr_return_fields (valtype, fields))
6747 case 1:
6748 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, FP_RETURN);
6750 case 2:
6751 return mips_return_fpr_pair (mode,
6752 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (fields[0])),
6753 int_byte_position (fields[0]),
6754 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (fields[1])),
6755 int_byte_position (fields[1]));
6758 /* If a value is passed in the most significant part of a register, see
6759 whether we have to round the mode up to a whole number of words. */
6760 if (mips_return_in_msb (valtype))
6762 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (valtype);
6763 if (size % UNITS_PER_WORD != 0)
6765 size += UNITS_PER_WORD - size % UNITS_PER_WORD;
6766 mode = mode_for_size (size * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 0);
6770 /* For EABI, the class of return register depends entirely on MODE.
6771 For example, "struct { some_type x; }" and "union { some_type x; }"
6772 are returned in the same way as a bare "some_type" would be.
6773 Other ABIs only use FPRs for scalar, complex or vector types. */
6774 if (mips_abi != ABI_EABI && !FLOAT_TYPE_P (valtype))
6775 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, GP_RETURN);
6778 if ((GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT
6779 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT)
6780 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= UNITS_PER_HWFPVALUE)
6781 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, FP_RETURN);
6783 /* Handle long doubles for n32 & n64. */
6784 if (mode == TFmode)
6785 return mips_return_fpr_pair (mode,
6786 DImode, 0,
6787 DImode, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / 2);
6789 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT
6790 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= UNITS_PER_HWFPVALUE * 2)
6791 return mips_return_fpr_pair (mode,
6792 GET_MODE_INNER (mode), 0,
6793 GET_MODE_INNER (mode),
6794 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / 2);
6796 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, GP_RETURN);
6799 /* Return nonzero when an argument must be passed by reference. */
6801 static bool
6802 mips_pass_by_reference (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6803 enum machine_mode mode, tree type,
6804 bool named ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6806 if (mips_abi == ABI_EABI)
6808 int size;
6810 /* ??? How should SCmode be handled? */
6811 if (type == NULL_TREE || mode == DImode || mode == DFmode)
6812 return 0;
6814 size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
6815 return size == -1 || size > UNITS_PER_WORD;
6817 else
6819 /* If we have a variable-sized parameter, we have no choice. */
6820 return targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack (mode, type);
6824 static bool
6825 mips_callee_copies (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6826 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6827 tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, bool named)
6829 return mips_abi == ABI_EABI && named;
6832 /* Return true if registers of class CLASS cannot change from mode FROM
6833 to mode TO. */
6835 bool
6836 mips_cannot_change_mode_class (enum machine_mode from,
6837 enum machine_mode to, enum reg_class class)
6839 if (MIN (GET_MODE_SIZE (from), GET_MODE_SIZE (to)) <= UNITS_PER_WORD
6840 && MAX (GET_MODE_SIZE (from), GET_MODE_SIZE (to)) > UNITS_PER_WORD)
6842 if (TARGET_BIG_ENDIAN)
6844 /* When a multi-word value is stored in paired floating-point
6845 registers, the first register always holds the low word.
6846 We therefore can't allow FPRs to change between single-word
6847 and multi-word modes. */
6848 if (FP_INC > 1 && reg_classes_intersect_p (FP_REGS, class))
6849 return true;
6851 else
6853 /* LO_REGNO == HI_REGNO + 1, so if a multi-word value is stored
6854 in LO and HI, the high word always comes first. We therefore
6855 can't allow values stored in HI to change between single-word
6856 and multi-word modes. */
6857 if (reg_classes_intersect_p (HI_REG, class))
6858 return true;
6861 /* Loading a 32-bit value into a 64-bit floating-point register
6862 will not sign-extend the value, despite what LOAD_EXTEND_OP says.
6863 We can't allow 64-bit float registers to change from SImode to
6864 to a wider mode. */
6865 if (TARGET_FLOAT64
6866 && from == SImode
6867 && GET_MODE_SIZE (to) >= UNITS_PER_WORD
6868 && reg_classes_intersect_p (FP_REGS, class))
6869 return true;
6870 return false;
6873 /* Return true if X should not be moved directly into register $25.
6874 We need this because many versions of GAS will treat "la $25,foo" as
6875 part of a call sequence and so allow a global "foo" to be lazily bound. */
6877 bool
6878 mips_dangerous_for_la25_p (rtx x)
6880 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
6882 if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS)
6883 return false;
6885 mips_split_const (x, &x, &offset);
6886 return global_got_operand (x, VOIDmode);
6889 /* Implement PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS. */
6891 enum reg_class
6892 mips_preferred_reload_class (rtx x, enum reg_class class)
6894 if (mips_dangerous_for_la25_p (x) && reg_class_subset_p (LEA_REGS, class))
6895 return LEA_REGS;
6897 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT
6898 && FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (x))
6899 && reg_class_subset_p (FP_REGS, class))
6900 return FP_REGS;
6902 if (reg_class_subset_p (GR_REGS, class))
6903 class = GR_REGS;
6905 if (TARGET_MIPS16 && reg_class_subset_p (M16_REGS, class))
6906 class = M16_REGS;
6908 return class;
6911 /* This function returns the register class required for a secondary
6912 register when copying between one of the registers in CLASS, and X,
6913 using MODE. If IN_P is nonzero, the copy is going from X to the
6914 register, otherwise the register is the source. A return value of
6915 NO_REGS means that no secondary register is required. */
6917 enum reg_class
6918 mips_secondary_reload_class (enum reg_class class,
6919 enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, int in_p)
6921 enum reg_class gr_regs = TARGET_MIPS16 ? M16_REGS : GR_REGS;
6922 int regno = -1;
6923 int gp_reg_p;
6925 if (REG_P (x)|| GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG)
6926 regno = true_regnum (x);
6928 gp_reg_p = TARGET_MIPS16 ? M16_REG_P (regno) : GP_REG_P (regno);
6930 if (mips_dangerous_for_la25_p (x))
6932 gr_regs = LEA_REGS;
6933 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (reg_class_contents[(int) class], 25))
6934 return gr_regs;
6937 /* Copying from HI or LO to anywhere other than a general register
6938 requires a general register. */
6939 if (class == HI_REG || class == LO_REG || class == MD_REGS)
6941 if (TARGET_MIPS16 && in_p)
6943 /* We can't really copy to HI or LO at all in mips16 mode. */
6944 return M16_REGS;
6946 return gp_reg_p ? NO_REGS : gr_regs;
6948 if (MD_REG_P (regno))
6950 if (TARGET_MIPS16 && ! in_p)
6952 /* We can't really copy to HI or LO at all in mips16 mode. */
6953 return M16_REGS;
6955 return class == gr_regs ? NO_REGS : gr_regs;
6958 /* We can only copy a value to a condition code register from a
6959 floating point register, and even then we require a scratch
6960 floating point register. We can only copy a value out of a
6961 condition code register into a general register. */
6962 if (class == ST_REGS)
6964 if (in_p)
6965 return FP_REGS;
6966 return gp_reg_p ? NO_REGS : gr_regs;
6968 if (ST_REG_P (regno))
6970 if (! in_p)
6971 return FP_REGS;
6972 return class == gr_regs ? NO_REGS : gr_regs;
6975 if (class == FP_REGS)
6977 if (MEM_P (x))
6979 /* In this case we can use lwc1, swc1, ldc1 or sdc1. */
6980 return NO_REGS;
6982 else if (CONSTANT_P (x) && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT)
6984 /* We can use the l.s and l.d macros to load floating-point
6985 constants. ??? For l.s, we could probably get better
6986 code by returning GR_REGS here. */
6987 return NO_REGS;
6989 else if (gp_reg_p || x == CONST0_RTX (mode))
6991 /* In this case we can use mtc1, mfc1, dmtc1 or dmfc1. */
6992 return NO_REGS;
6994 else if (FP_REG_P (regno))
6996 /* In this case we can use mov.s or mov.d. */
6997 return NO_REGS;
6999 else
7001 /* Otherwise, we need to reload through an integer register. */
7002 return gr_regs;
7006 /* In mips16 mode, going between memory and anything but M16_REGS
7007 requires an M16_REG. */
7008 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
7010 if (class != M16_REGS && class != M16_NA_REGS)
7012 if (gp_reg_p)
7013 return NO_REGS;
7014 return M16_REGS;
7016 if (! gp_reg_p)
7018 if (class == M16_REGS || class == M16_NA_REGS)
7019 return NO_REGS;
7020 return M16_REGS;
7024 return NO_REGS;
7027 /* Implement CLASS_MAX_NREGS.
7029 Usually all registers are word-sized. The only supported exception
7030 is -mgp64 -msingle-float, which has 64-bit words but 32-bit float
7031 registers. A word-based calculation is correct even in that case,
7032 since -msingle-float disallows multi-FPR values.
7034 The FP status registers are an exception to this rule. They are always
7035 4 bytes wide as they only hold condition code modes, and CCmode is always
7036 considered to be 4 bytes wide. */
7039 mips_class_max_nregs (enum reg_class class ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7040 enum machine_mode mode)
7042 if (class == ST_REGS)
7043 return (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + 3) / 4;
7044 else
7045 return (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
7048 static bool
7049 mips_valid_pointer_mode (enum machine_mode mode)
7051 return (mode == SImode || (TARGET_64BIT && mode == DImode));
7054 /* Define this so that we can deal with a testcase like:
7056 char foo __attribute__ ((mode (SI)));
7058 then compiled with -mabi=64 and -mint64. We have no
7059 32-bit type at that point and so the default case
7060 always fails. */
7062 static bool
7063 mips_scalar_mode_supported_p (enum machine_mode mode)
7065 switch (mode)
7067 case QImode:
7068 case HImode:
7069 case SImode:
7070 case DImode:
7071 return true;
7073 /* Handled via optabs.c. */
7074 case TImode:
7075 return TARGET_64BIT;
7077 case SFmode:
7078 case DFmode:
7079 return true;
7081 /* LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE is 128 for TARGET_NEWABI only. */
7082 case TFmode:
7083 return TARGET_NEWABI;
7085 default:
7086 return false;
7091 /* Target hook for vector_mode_supported_p. */
7092 static bool
7093 mips_vector_mode_supported_p (enum machine_mode mode)
7095 if (mode == V2SFmode && TARGET_PAIRED_SINGLE_FLOAT)
7096 return true;
7097 else
7098 return false;
7101 /* If we can access small data directly (using gp-relative relocation
7102 operators) return the small data pointer, otherwise return null.
7104 For each mips16 function which refers to GP relative symbols, we
7105 use a pseudo register, initialized at the start of the function, to
7106 hold the $gp value. */
7108 static rtx
7109 mips16_gp_pseudo_reg (void)
7111 if (cfun->machine->mips16_gp_pseudo_rtx == NULL_RTX)
7113 rtx unspec;
7114 rtx insn, scan;
7116 cfun->machine->mips16_gp_pseudo_rtx = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
7118 /* We want to initialize this to a value which gcc will believe
7119 is constant. */
7120 start_sequence ();
7121 unspec = gen_rtx_UNSPEC (VOIDmode, gen_rtvec (1, const0_rtx), UNSPEC_GP);
7122 emit_move_insn (cfun->machine->mips16_gp_pseudo_rtx,
7123 gen_rtx_CONST (Pmode, unspec));
7124 insn = get_insns ();
7125 end_sequence ();
7127 push_topmost_sequence ();
7128 /* We need to emit the initialization after the FUNCTION_BEG
7129 note, so that it will be integrated. */
7130 for (scan = get_insns (); scan != NULL_RTX; scan = NEXT_INSN (scan))
7131 if (NOTE_P (scan)
7132 && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (scan) == NOTE_INSN_FUNCTION_BEG)
7133 break;
7134 if (scan == NULL_RTX)
7135 scan = get_insns ();
7136 insn = emit_insn_after (insn, scan);
7137 pop_topmost_sequence ();
7140 return cfun->machine->mips16_gp_pseudo_rtx;
7143 /* Write out code to move floating point arguments in or out of
7144 general registers. Output the instructions to FILE. FP_CODE is
7145 the code describing which arguments are present (see the comment at
7146 the definition of CUMULATIVE_ARGS in mips.h). FROM_FP_P is nonzero if
7147 we are copying from the floating point registers. */
7149 static void
7150 mips16_fp_args (FILE *file, int fp_code, int from_fp_p)
7152 const char *s;
7153 int gparg, fparg;
7154 unsigned int f;
7156 /* This code only works for the original 32 bit ABI and the O64 ABI. */
7157 gcc_assert (TARGET_OLDABI);
7159 if (from_fp_p)
7160 s = "mfc1";
7161 else
7162 s = "mtc1";
7163 gparg = GP_ARG_FIRST;
7164 fparg = FP_ARG_FIRST;
7165 for (f = (unsigned int) fp_code; f != 0; f >>= 2)
7167 if ((f & 3) == 1)
7169 if ((fparg & 1) != 0)
7170 ++fparg;
7171 fprintf (file, "\t%s\t%s,%s\n", s,
7172 reg_names[gparg], reg_names[fparg]);
7174 else if ((f & 3) == 2)
7176 if (TARGET_64BIT)
7177 fprintf (file, "\td%s\t%s,%s\n", s,
7178 reg_names[gparg], reg_names[fparg]);
7179 else
7181 if ((fparg & 1) != 0)
7182 ++fparg;
7183 if (TARGET_BIG_ENDIAN)
7184 fprintf (file, "\t%s\t%s,%s\n\t%s\t%s,%s\n", s,
7185 reg_names[gparg], reg_names[fparg + 1], s,
7186 reg_names[gparg + 1], reg_names[fparg]);
7187 else
7188 fprintf (file, "\t%s\t%s,%s\n\t%s\t%s,%s\n", s,
7189 reg_names[gparg], reg_names[fparg], s,
7190 reg_names[gparg + 1], reg_names[fparg + 1]);
7191 ++gparg;
7192 ++fparg;
7195 else
7196 gcc_unreachable ();
7198 ++gparg;
7199 ++fparg;
7203 /* Build a mips16 function stub. This is used for functions which
7204 take arguments in the floating point registers. It is 32 bit code
7205 that moves the floating point args into the general registers, and
7206 then jumps to the 16 bit code. */
7208 static void
7209 build_mips16_function_stub (FILE *file)
7211 const char *fnname;
7212 char *secname, *stubname;
7213 tree stubid, stubdecl;
7214 int need_comma;
7215 unsigned int f;
7217 fnname = XSTR (XEXP (DECL_RTL (current_function_decl), 0), 0);
7218 secname = (char *) alloca (strlen (fnname) + 20);
7219 sprintf (secname, ".mips16.fn.%s", fnname);
7220 stubname = (char *) alloca (strlen (fnname) + 20);
7221 sprintf (stubname, "__fn_stub_%s", fnname);
7222 stubid = get_identifier (stubname);
7223 stubdecl = build_decl (FUNCTION_DECL, stubid,
7224 build_function_type (void_type_node, NULL_TREE));
7225 DECL_SECTION_NAME (stubdecl) = build_string (strlen (secname), secname);
7227 fprintf (file, "\t# Stub function for %s (", current_function_name ());
7228 need_comma = 0;
7229 for (f = (unsigned int) current_function_args_info.fp_code; f != 0; f >>= 2)
7231 fprintf (file, "%s%s",
7232 need_comma ? ", " : "",
7233 (f & 3) == 1 ? "float" : "double");
7234 need_comma = 1;
7236 fprintf (file, ")\n");
7238 fprintf (file, "\t.set\tnomips16\n");
7239 function_section (stubdecl);
7240 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (file, floor_log2 (FUNCTION_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT));
7242 /* ??? If FUNCTION_NAME_ALREADY_DECLARED is defined, then we are
7243 within a .ent, and we cannot emit another .ent. */
7244 if (!FUNCTION_NAME_ALREADY_DECLARED)
7246 fputs ("\t.ent\t", file);
7247 assemble_name (file, stubname);
7248 fputs ("\n", file);
7251 assemble_name (file, stubname);
7252 fputs (":\n", file);
7254 /* We don't want the assembler to insert any nops here. */
7255 fprintf (file, "\t.set\tnoreorder\n");
7257 mips16_fp_args (file, current_function_args_info.fp_code, 1);
7259 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.set\tnoat\n");
7260 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tla\t%s,", reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST + 1]);
7261 assemble_name (file, fnname);
7262 fprintf (file, "\n");
7263 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tjr\t%s\n", reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST + 1]);
7264 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.set\tat\n");
7266 /* Unfortunately, we can't fill the jump delay slot. We can't fill
7267 with one of the mfc1 instructions, because the result is not
7268 available for one instruction, so if the very first instruction
7269 in the function refers to the register, it will see the wrong
7270 value. */
7271 fprintf (file, "\tnop\n");
7273 fprintf (file, "\t.set\treorder\n");
7275 if (!FUNCTION_NAME_ALREADY_DECLARED)
7277 fputs ("\t.end\t", file);
7278 assemble_name (file, stubname);
7279 fputs ("\n", file);
7282 fprintf (file, "\t.set\tmips16\n");
7284 function_section (current_function_decl);
7287 /* We keep a list of functions for which we have already built stubs
7288 in build_mips16_call_stub. */
7290 struct mips16_stub
7292 struct mips16_stub *next;
7293 char *name;
7294 int fpret;
7297 static struct mips16_stub *mips16_stubs;
7299 /* Build a call stub for a mips16 call. A stub is needed if we are
7300 passing any floating point values which should go into the floating
7301 point registers. If we are, and the call turns out to be to a 32
7302 bit function, the stub will be used to move the values into the
7303 floating point registers before calling the 32 bit function. The
7304 linker will magically adjust the function call to either the 16 bit
7305 function or the 32 bit stub, depending upon where the function call
7306 is actually defined.
7308 Similarly, we need a stub if the return value might come back in a
7309 floating point register.
7311 RETVAL is the location of the return value, or null if this is
7312 a call rather than a call_value. FN is the address of the
7313 function and ARG_SIZE is the size of the arguments. FP_CODE
7314 is the code built by function_arg. This function returns a nonzero
7315 value if it builds the call instruction itself. */
7318 build_mips16_call_stub (rtx retval, rtx fn, rtx arg_size, int fp_code)
7320 int fpret;
7321 const char *fnname;
7322 char *secname, *stubname;
7323 struct mips16_stub *l;
7324 tree stubid, stubdecl;
7325 int need_comma;
7326 unsigned int f;
7328 /* We don't need to do anything if we aren't in mips16 mode, or if
7329 we were invoked with the -msoft-float option. */
7330 if (! TARGET_MIPS16 || ! mips16_hard_float)
7331 return 0;
7333 /* Figure out whether the value might come back in a floating point
7334 register. */
7335 fpret = (retval != 0
7336 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (retval)) == MODE_FLOAT
7337 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (retval)) <= UNITS_PER_FPVALUE);
7339 /* We don't need to do anything if there were no floating point
7340 arguments and the value will not be returned in a floating point
7341 register. */
7342 if (fp_code == 0 && ! fpret)
7343 return 0;
7345 /* We don't need to do anything if this is a call to a special
7346 mips16 support function. */
7347 if (GET_CODE (fn) == SYMBOL_REF
7348 && strncmp (XSTR (fn, 0), "__mips16_", 9) == 0)
7349 return 0;
7351 /* This code will only work for o32 and o64 abis. The other ABI's
7352 require more sophisticated support. */
7353 gcc_assert (TARGET_OLDABI);
7355 /* We can only handle SFmode and DFmode floating point return
7356 values. */
7357 if (fpret)
7358 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (retval) == SFmode || GET_MODE (retval) == DFmode);
7360 /* If we're calling via a function pointer, then we must always call
7361 via a stub. There are magic stubs provided in libgcc.a for each
7362 of the required cases. Each of them expects the function address
7363 to arrive in register $2. */
7365 if (GET_CODE (fn) != SYMBOL_REF)
7367 char buf[30];
7368 tree id;
7369 rtx stub_fn, insn;
7371 /* ??? If this code is modified to support other ABI's, we need
7372 to handle PARALLEL return values here. */
7374 sprintf (buf, "__mips16_call_stub_%s%d",
7375 (fpret
7376 ? (GET_MODE (retval) == SFmode ? "sf_" : "df_")
7377 : ""),
7378 fp_code);
7379 id = get_identifier (buf);
7380 stub_fn = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (id));
7382 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 2), fn);
7384 if (retval == NULL_RTX)
7385 insn = gen_call_internal (stub_fn, arg_size);
7386 else
7387 insn = gen_call_value_internal (retval, stub_fn, arg_size);
7388 insn = emit_call_insn (insn);
7390 /* Put the register usage information on the CALL. */
7391 CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn) =
7392 gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode,
7393 gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 2)),
7394 CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn));
7396 /* If we are handling a floating point return value, we need to
7397 save $18 in the function prologue. Putting a note on the
7398 call will mean that regs_ever_live[$18] will be true if the
7399 call is not eliminated, and we can check that in the prologue
7400 code. */
7401 if (fpret)
7402 CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn) =
7403 gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode,
7404 gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode,
7405 gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, 18)),
7406 CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn));
7408 /* Return 1 to tell the caller that we've generated the call
7409 insn. */
7410 return 1;
7413 /* We know the function we are going to call. If we have already
7414 built a stub, we don't need to do anything further. */
7416 fnname = XSTR (fn, 0);
7417 for (l = mips16_stubs; l != NULL; l = l->next)
7418 if (strcmp (l->name, fnname) == 0)
7419 break;
7421 if (l == NULL)
7423 /* Build a special purpose stub. When the linker sees a
7424 function call in mips16 code, it will check where the target
7425 is defined. If the target is a 32 bit call, the linker will
7426 search for the section defined here. It can tell which
7427 symbol this section is associated with by looking at the
7428 relocation information (the name is unreliable, since this
7429 might be a static function). If such a section is found, the
7430 linker will redirect the call to the start of the magic
7431 section.
7433 If the function does not return a floating point value, the
7434 special stub section is named
7435 .mips16.call.FNNAME
7437 If the function does return a floating point value, the stub
7438 section is named
7439 .mips16.call.fp.FNNAME
7442 secname = (char *) alloca (strlen (fnname) + 40);
7443 sprintf (secname, ".mips16.call.%s%s",
7444 fpret ? "fp." : "",
7445 fnname);
7446 stubname = (char *) alloca (strlen (fnname) + 20);
7447 sprintf (stubname, "__call_stub_%s%s",
7448 fpret ? "fp_" : "",
7449 fnname);
7450 stubid = get_identifier (stubname);
7451 stubdecl = build_decl (FUNCTION_DECL, stubid,
7452 build_function_type (void_type_node, NULL_TREE));
7453 DECL_SECTION_NAME (stubdecl) = build_string (strlen (secname), secname);
7455 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t# Stub function to call %s%s (",
7456 (fpret
7457 ? (GET_MODE (retval) == SFmode ? "float " : "double ")
7458 : ""),
7459 fnname);
7460 need_comma = 0;
7461 for (f = (unsigned int) fp_code; f != 0; f >>= 2)
7463 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%s%s",
7464 need_comma ? ", " : "",
7465 (f & 3) == 1 ? "float" : "double");
7466 need_comma = 1;
7468 fprintf (asm_out_file, ")\n");
7470 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.set\tnomips16\n");
7471 assemble_start_function (stubdecl, stubname);
7473 if (!FUNCTION_NAME_ALREADY_DECLARED)
7475 fputs ("\t.ent\t", asm_out_file);
7476 assemble_name (asm_out_file, stubname);
7477 fputs ("\n", asm_out_file);
7479 assemble_name (asm_out_file, stubname);
7480 fputs (":\n", asm_out_file);
7483 /* We build the stub code by hand. That's the only way we can
7484 do it, since we can't generate 32 bit code during a 16 bit
7485 compilation. */
7487 /* We don't want the assembler to insert any nops here. */
7488 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.set\tnoreorder\n");
7490 mips16_fp_args (asm_out_file, fp_code, 0);
7492 if (! fpret)
7494 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.set\tnoat\n");
7495 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tla\t%s,%s\n", reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST + 1],
7496 fnname);
7497 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tjr\t%s\n", reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST + 1]);
7498 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.set\tat\n");
7499 /* Unfortunately, we can't fill the jump delay slot. We
7500 can't fill with one of the mtc1 instructions, because the
7501 result is not available for one instruction, so if the
7502 very first instruction in the function refers to the
7503 register, it will see the wrong value. */
7504 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tnop\n");
7506 else
7508 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tmove\t%s,%s\n",
7509 reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST + 18], reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST + 31]);
7510 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tjal\t%s\n", fnname);
7511 /* As above, we can't fill the delay slot. */
7512 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tnop\n");
7513 if (GET_MODE (retval) == SFmode)
7514 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tmfc1\t%s,%s\n",
7515 reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST + 2], reg_names[FP_REG_FIRST + 0]);
7516 else
7518 if (TARGET_BIG_ENDIAN)
7520 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tmfc1\t%s,%s\n",
7521 reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST + 2],
7522 reg_names[FP_REG_FIRST + 1]);
7523 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tmfc1\t%s,%s\n",
7524 reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST + 3],
7525 reg_names[FP_REG_FIRST + 0]);
7527 else
7529 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tmfc1\t%s,%s\n",
7530 reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST + 2],
7531 reg_names[FP_REG_FIRST + 0]);
7532 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tmfc1\t%s,%s\n",
7533 reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST + 3],
7534 reg_names[FP_REG_FIRST + 1]);
7537 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tj\t%s\n", reg_names[GP_REG_FIRST + 18]);
7538 /* As above, we can't fill the delay slot. */
7539 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tnop\n");
7542 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.set\treorder\n");
7544 #ifdef ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE
7545 ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (asm_out_file, stubname, stubdecl);
7546 #endif
7548 if (!FUNCTION_NAME_ALREADY_DECLARED)
7550 fputs ("\t.end\t", asm_out_file);
7551 assemble_name (asm_out_file, stubname);
7552 fputs ("\n", asm_out_file);
7555 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.set\tmips16\n");
7557 /* Record this stub. */
7558 l = (struct mips16_stub *) xmalloc (sizeof *l);
7559 l->name = xstrdup (fnname);
7560 l->fpret = fpret;
7561 l->next = mips16_stubs;
7562 mips16_stubs = l;
7565 /* If we expect a floating point return value, but we've built a
7566 stub which does not expect one, then we're in trouble. We can't
7567 use the existing stub, because it won't handle the floating point
7568 value. We can't build a new stub, because the linker won't know
7569 which stub to use for the various calls in this object file.
7570 Fortunately, this case is illegal, since it means that a function
7571 was declared in two different ways in a single compilation. */
7572 if (fpret && ! l->fpret)
7573 error ("cannot handle inconsistent calls to %qs", fnname);
7575 /* If we are calling a stub which handles a floating point return
7576 value, we need to arrange to save $18 in the prologue. We do
7577 this by marking the function call as using the register. The
7578 prologue will later see that it is used, and emit code to save
7579 it. */
7581 if (l->fpret)
7583 rtx insn;
7585 if (retval == NULL_RTX)
7586 insn = gen_call_internal (fn, arg_size);
7587 else
7588 insn = gen_call_value_internal (retval, fn, arg_size);
7589 insn = emit_call_insn (insn);
7591 CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn) =
7592 gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode,
7593 gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, 18)),
7594 CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn));
7596 /* Return 1 to tell the caller that we've generated the call
7597 insn. */
7598 return 1;
7601 /* Return 0 to let the caller generate the call insn. */
7602 return 0;
7605 /* An entry in the mips16 constant pool. VALUE is the pool constant,
7606 MODE is its mode, and LABEL is the CODE_LABEL associated with it. */
7608 struct mips16_constant {
7609 struct mips16_constant *next;
7610 rtx value;
7611 rtx label;
7612 enum machine_mode mode;
7615 /* Information about an incomplete mips16 constant pool. FIRST is the
7616 first constant, HIGHEST_ADDRESS is the highest address that the first
7617 byte of the pool can have, and INSN_ADDRESS is the current instruction
7618 address. */
7620 struct mips16_constant_pool {
7621 struct mips16_constant *first;
7622 int highest_address;
7623 int insn_address;
7626 /* Add constant VALUE to POOL and return its label. MODE is the
7627 value's mode (used for CONST_INTs, etc.). */
7629 static rtx
7630 add_constant (struct mips16_constant_pool *pool,
7631 rtx value, enum machine_mode mode)
7633 struct mips16_constant **p, *c;
7634 bool first_of_size_p;
7636 /* See whether the constant is already in the pool. If so, return the
7637 existing label, otherwise leave P pointing to the place where the
7638 constant should be added.
7640 Keep the pool sorted in increasing order of mode size so that we can
7641 reduce the number of alignments needed. */
7642 first_of_size_p = true;
7643 for (p = &pool->first; *p != 0; p = &(*p)->next)
7645 if (mode == (*p)->mode && rtx_equal_p (value, (*p)->value))
7646 return (*p)->label;
7647 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE ((*p)->mode))
7648 break;
7649 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == GET_MODE_SIZE ((*p)->mode))
7650 first_of_size_p = false;
7653 /* In the worst case, the constant needed by the earliest instruction
7654 will end up at the end of the pool. The entire pool must then be
7655 accessible from that instruction.
7657 When adding the first constant, set the pool's highest address to
7658 the address of the first out-of-range byte. Adjust this address
7659 downwards each time a new constant is added. */
7660 if (pool->first == 0)
7661 /* For pc-relative lw, addiu and daddiu instructions, the base PC value
7662 is the address of the instruction with the lowest two bits clear.
7663 The base PC value for ld has the lowest three bits clear. Assume
7664 the worst case here. */
7665 pool->highest_address = pool->insn_address - (UNITS_PER_WORD - 2) + 0x8000;
7666 pool->highest_address -= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
7667 if (first_of_size_p)
7668 /* Take into account the worst possible padding due to alignment. */
7669 pool->highest_address -= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - 1;
7671 /* Create a new entry. */
7672 c = (struct mips16_constant *) xmalloc (sizeof *c);
7673 c->value = value;
7674 c->mode = mode;
7675 c->label = gen_label_rtx ();
7676 c->next = *p;
7677 *p = c;
7679 return c->label;
7682 /* Output constant VALUE after instruction INSN and return the last
7683 instruction emitted. MODE is the mode of the constant. */
7685 static rtx
7686 dump_constants_1 (enum machine_mode mode, rtx value, rtx insn)
7688 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
7690 case MODE_INT:
7692 rtx size = GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
7693 return emit_insn_after (gen_consttable_int (value, size), insn);
7696 case MODE_FLOAT:
7697 return emit_insn_after (gen_consttable_float (value), insn);
7699 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
7700 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
7702 int i;
7703 for (i = 0; i < CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (value); i++)
7704 insn = dump_constants_1 (GET_MODE_INNER (mode),
7705 CONST_VECTOR_ELT (value, i), insn);
7706 return insn;
7709 default:
7710 gcc_unreachable ();
7715 /* Dump out the constants in CONSTANTS after INSN. */
7717 static void
7718 dump_constants (struct mips16_constant *constants, rtx insn)
7720 struct mips16_constant *c, *next;
7721 int align;
7723 align = 0;
7724 for (c = constants; c != NULL; c = next)
7726 /* If necessary, increase the alignment of PC. */
7727 if (align < GET_MODE_SIZE (c->mode))
7729 int align_log = floor_log2 (GET_MODE_SIZE (c->mode));
7730 insn = emit_insn_after (gen_align (GEN_INT (align_log)), insn);
7732 align = GET_MODE_SIZE (c->mode);
7734 insn = emit_label_after (c->label, insn);
7735 insn = dump_constants_1 (c->mode, c->value, insn);
7737 next = c->next;
7738 free (c);
7741 emit_barrier_after (insn);
7744 /* Return the length of instruction INSN.
7746 ??? MIPS16 switch tables go in .text, but we don't define
7747 JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION, so get_attr_length will not
7748 compute their lengths correctly. */
7750 static int
7751 mips16_insn_length (rtx insn)
7753 if (JUMP_P (insn))
7755 rtx body = PATTERN (insn);
7756 if (GET_CODE (body) == ADDR_VEC)
7757 return GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (body)) * XVECLEN (body, 0);
7758 if (GET_CODE (body) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC)
7759 return GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (body)) * XVECLEN (body, 1);
7761 return get_attr_length (insn);
7764 /* Rewrite *X so that constant pool references refer to the constant's
7765 label instead. DATA points to the constant pool structure. */
7767 static int
7768 mips16_rewrite_pool_refs (rtx *x, void *data)
7770 struct mips16_constant_pool *pool = data;
7771 if (GET_CODE (*x) == SYMBOL_REF && CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (*x))
7772 *x = gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (Pmode, add_constant (pool,
7773 get_pool_constant (*x),
7774 get_pool_mode (*x)));
7775 return 0;
7778 /* Build MIPS16 constant pools. */
7780 static void
7781 mips16_lay_out_constants (void)
7783 struct mips16_constant_pool pool;
7784 rtx insn, barrier;
7786 barrier = 0;
7787 memset (&pool, 0, sizeof (pool));
7788 for (insn = get_insns (); insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
7790 /* Rewrite constant pool references in INSN. */
7791 if (INSN_P (insn))
7792 for_each_rtx (&PATTERN (insn), mips16_rewrite_pool_refs, &pool);
7794 pool.insn_address += mips16_insn_length (insn);
7796 if (pool.first != NULL)
7798 /* If there are no natural barriers between the first user of
7799 the pool and the highest acceptable address, we'll need to
7800 create a new instruction to jump around the constant pool.
7801 In the worst case, this instruction will be 4 bytes long.
7803 If it's too late to do this transformation after INSN,
7804 do it immediately before INSN. */
7805 if (barrier == 0 && pool.insn_address + 4 > pool.highest_address)
7807 rtx label, jump;
7809 label = gen_label_rtx ();
7811 jump = emit_jump_insn_before (gen_jump (label), insn);
7812 JUMP_LABEL (jump) = label;
7813 LABEL_NUSES (label) = 1;
7814 barrier = emit_barrier_after (jump);
7816 emit_label_after (label, barrier);
7817 pool.insn_address += 4;
7820 /* See whether the constant pool is now out of range of the first
7821 user. If so, output the constants after the previous barrier.
7822 Note that any instructions between BARRIER and INSN (inclusive)
7823 will use negative offsets to refer to the pool. */
7824 if (pool.insn_address > pool.highest_address)
7826 dump_constants (pool.first, barrier);
7827 pool.first = NULL;
7828 barrier = 0;
7830 else if (BARRIER_P (insn))
7831 barrier = insn;
7834 dump_constants (pool.first, get_last_insn ());
7837 /* A temporary variable used by for_each_rtx callbacks, etc. */
7838 static rtx mips_sim_insn;
7840 /* A structure representing the state of the processor pipeline.
7841 Used by the mips_sim_* family of functions. */
7842 struct mips_sim {
7843 /* The maximum number of instructions that can be issued in a cycle.
7844 (Caches mips_issue_rate.) */
7845 unsigned int issue_rate;
7847 /* The current simulation time. */
7848 unsigned int time;
7850 /* How many more instructions can be issued in the current cycle. */
7851 unsigned int insns_left;
7853 /* LAST_SET[X].INSN is the last instruction to set register X.
7854 LAST_SET[X].TIME is the time at which that instruction was issued.
7855 INSN is null if no instruction has yet set register X. */
7856 struct {
7857 rtx insn;
7858 unsigned int time;
7859 } last_set[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
7861 /* The pipeline's current DFA state. */
7862 state_t dfa_state;
7865 /* Reset STATE to the initial simulation state. */
7867 static void
7868 mips_sim_reset (struct mips_sim *state)
7870 state->time = 0;
7871 state->insns_left = state->issue_rate;
7872 memset (&state->last_set, 0, sizeof (state->last_set));
7873 state_reset (state->dfa_state);
7876 /* Initialize STATE before its first use. DFA_STATE points to an
7877 allocated but uninitialized DFA state. */
7879 static void
7880 mips_sim_init (struct mips_sim *state, state_t dfa_state)
7882 state->issue_rate = mips_issue_rate ();
7883 state->dfa_state = dfa_state;
7884 mips_sim_reset (state);
7887 /* Advance STATE by one clock cycle. */
7889 static void
7890 mips_sim_next_cycle (struct mips_sim *state)
7892 state->time++;
7893 state->insns_left = state->issue_rate;
7894 state_transition (state->dfa_state, 0);
7897 /* Advance simulation state STATE until instruction INSN can read
7898 register REG. */
7900 static void
7901 mips_sim_wait_reg (struct mips_sim *state, rtx insn, rtx reg)
7903 unsigned int i;
7905 for (i = 0; i < HARD_REGNO_NREGS (REGNO (reg), GET_MODE (reg)); i++)
7906 if (state->last_set[REGNO (reg) + i].insn != 0)
7908 unsigned int t;
7910 t = state->last_set[REGNO (reg) + i].time;
7911 t += insn_latency (state->last_set[REGNO (reg) + i].insn, insn);
7912 while (state->time < t)
7913 mips_sim_next_cycle (state);
7917 /* A for_each_rtx callback. If *X is a register, advance simulation state
7918 DATA until mips_sim_insn can read the register's value. */
7920 static int
7921 mips_sim_wait_regs_2 (rtx *x, void *data)
7923 if (REG_P (*x))
7924 mips_sim_wait_reg (data, mips_sim_insn, *x);
7925 return 0;
7928 /* Call mips_sim_wait_regs_2 (R, DATA) for each register R mentioned in *X. */
7930 static void
7931 mips_sim_wait_regs_1 (rtx *x, void *data)
7933 for_each_rtx (x, mips_sim_wait_regs_2, data);
7936 /* Advance simulation state STATE until all of INSN's register
7937 dependencies are satisfied. */
7939 static void
7940 mips_sim_wait_regs (struct mips_sim *state, rtx insn)
7942 mips_sim_insn = insn;
7943 note_uses (&PATTERN (insn), mips_sim_wait_regs_1, state);
7946 /* Advance simulation state STATE until the units required by
7947 instruction INSN are available. */
7949 static void
7950 mips_sim_wait_units (struct mips_sim *state, rtx insn)
7952 state_t tmp_state;
7954 tmp_state = alloca (state_size ());
7955 while (state->insns_left == 0
7956 || (memcpy (tmp_state, state->dfa_state, state_size ()),
7957 state_transition (tmp_state, insn) >= 0))
7958 mips_sim_next_cycle (state);
7961 /* Advance simulation state STATE until INSN is ready to issue. */
7963 static void
7964 mips_sim_wait_insn (struct mips_sim *state, rtx insn)
7966 mips_sim_wait_regs (state, insn);
7967 mips_sim_wait_units (state, insn);
7970 /* mips_sim_insn has just set X. Update the LAST_SET array
7971 in simulation state DATA. */
7973 static void
7974 mips_sim_record_set (rtx x, rtx pat ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *data)
7976 struct mips_sim *state;
7977 unsigned int i;
7979 state = data;
7980 if (REG_P (x))
7981 for (i = 0; i < HARD_REGNO_NREGS (REGNO (x), GET_MODE (x)); i++)
7983 state->last_set[REGNO (x) + i].insn = mips_sim_insn;
7984 state->last_set[REGNO (x) + i].time = state->time;
7988 /* Issue instruction INSN in scheduler state STATE. Assume that INSN
7989 can issue immediately (i.e., that mips_sim_wait_insn has already
7990 been called). */
7992 static void
7993 mips_sim_issue_insn (struct mips_sim *state, rtx insn)
7995 state_transition (state->dfa_state, insn);
7996 state->insns_left--;
7998 mips_sim_insn = insn;
7999 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), mips_sim_record_set, state);
8002 /* Simulate issuing a NOP in state STATE. */
8004 static void
8005 mips_sim_issue_nop (struct mips_sim *state)
8007 if (state->insns_left == 0)
8008 mips_sim_next_cycle (state);
8009 state->insns_left--;
8012 /* Update simulation state STATE so that it's ready to accept the instruction
8013 after INSN. INSN should be part of the main rtl chain, not a member of a
8014 SEQUENCE. */
8016 static void
8017 mips_sim_finish_insn (struct mips_sim *state, rtx insn)
8019 /* If INSN is a jump with an implicit delay slot, simulate a nop. */
8020 if (JUMP_P (insn))
8021 mips_sim_issue_nop (state);
8023 switch (GET_CODE (SEQ_BEGIN (insn)))
8025 case CODE_LABEL:
8026 case CALL_INSN:
8027 /* We can't predict the processor state after a call or label. */
8028 mips_sim_reset (state);
8029 break;
8031 case JUMP_INSN:
8032 /* The delay slots of branch likely instructions are only executed
8033 when the branch is taken. Therefore, if the caller has simulated
8034 the delay slot instruction, STATE does not really reflect the state
8035 of the pipeline for the instruction after the delay slot. Also,
8036 branch likely instructions tend to incur a penalty when not taken,
8037 so there will probably be an extra delay between the branch and
8038 the instruction after the delay slot. */
8039 if (INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P (SEQ_BEGIN (insn)))
8040 mips_sim_reset (state);
8041 break;
8043 default:
8044 break;
8048 /* The VR4130 pipeline issues aligned pairs of instructions together,
8049 but it stalls the second instruction if it depends on the first.
8050 In order to cut down the amount of logic required, this dependence
8051 check is not based on a full instruction decode. Instead, any non-SPECIAL
8052 instruction is assumed to modify the register specified by bits 20-16
8053 (which is usually the "rt" field).
8055 In beq, beql, bne and bnel instructions, the rt field is actually an
8056 input, so we can end up with a false dependence between the branch
8057 and its delay slot. If this situation occurs in instruction INSN,
8058 try to avoid it by swapping rs and rt. */
8060 static void
8061 vr4130_avoid_branch_rt_conflict (rtx insn)
8063 rtx first, second;
8065 first = SEQ_BEGIN (insn);
8066 second = SEQ_END (insn);
8067 if (JUMP_P (first)
8068 && NONJUMP_INSN_P (second)
8069 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (first)) == SET
8070 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (PATTERN (first))) == PC
8071 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (PATTERN (first))) == IF_THEN_ELSE)
8073 /* Check for the right kind of condition. */
8074 rtx cond = XEXP (SET_SRC (PATTERN (first)), 0);
8075 if ((GET_CODE (cond) == EQ || GET_CODE (cond) == NE)
8076 && REG_P (XEXP (cond, 0))
8077 && REG_P (XEXP (cond, 1))
8078 && reg_referenced_p (XEXP (cond, 1), PATTERN (second))
8079 && !reg_referenced_p (XEXP (cond, 0), PATTERN (second)))
8081 /* SECOND mentions the rt register but not the rs register. */
8082 rtx tmp = XEXP (cond, 0);
8083 XEXP (cond, 0) = XEXP (cond, 1);
8084 XEXP (cond, 1) = tmp;
8089 /* Implement -mvr4130-align. Go through each basic block and simulate the
8090 processor pipeline. If we find that a pair of instructions could execute
8091 in parallel, and the first of those instruction is not 8-byte aligned,
8092 insert a nop to make it aligned. */
8094 static void
8095 vr4130_align_insns (void)
8097 struct mips_sim state;
8098 rtx insn, subinsn, last, last2, next;
8099 bool aligned_p;
8101 dfa_start ();
8103 /* LAST is the last instruction before INSN to have a nonzero length.
8104 LAST2 is the last such instruction before LAST. */
8105 last = 0;
8106 last2 = 0;
8108 /* ALIGNED_P is true if INSN is known to be at an aligned address. */
8109 aligned_p = true;
8111 mips_sim_init (&state, alloca (state_size ()));
8112 for (insn = get_insns (); insn != 0; insn = next)
8114 unsigned int length;
8116 next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
8118 /* See the comment above vr4130_avoid_branch_rt_conflict for details.
8119 This isn't really related to the alignment pass, but we do it on
8120 the fly to avoid a separate instruction walk. */
8121 vr4130_avoid_branch_rt_conflict (insn);
8123 if (USEFUL_INSN_P (insn))
8124 FOR_EACH_SUBINSN (subinsn, insn)
8126 mips_sim_wait_insn (&state, subinsn);
8128 /* If we want this instruction to issue in parallel with the
8129 previous one, make sure that the previous instruction is
8130 aligned. There are several reasons why this isn't worthwhile
8131 when the second instruction is a call:
8133 - Calls are less likely to be performance critical,
8134 - There's a good chance that the delay slot can execute
8135 in parallel with the call.
8136 - The return address would then be unaligned.
8138 In general, if we're going to insert a nop between instructions
8139 X and Y, it's better to insert it immediately after X. That
8140 way, if the nop makes Y aligned, it will also align any labels
8141 between X and Y. */
8142 if (state.insns_left != state.issue_rate
8143 && !CALL_P (subinsn))
8145 if (subinsn == SEQ_BEGIN (insn) && aligned_p)
8147 /* SUBINSN is the first instruction in INSN and INSN is
8148 aligned. We want to align the previous instruction
8149 instead, so insert a nop between LAST2 and LAST.
8151 Note that LAST could be either a single instruction
8152 or a branch with a delay slot. In the latter case,
8153 LAST, like INSN, is already aligned, but the delay
8154 slot must have some extra delay that stops it from
8155 issuing at the same time as the branch. We therefore
8156 insert a nop before the branch in order to align its
8157 delay slot. */
8158 emit_insn_after (gen_nop (), last2);
8159 aligned_p = false;
8161 else if (subinsn != SEQ_BEGIN (insn) && !aligned_p)
8163 /* SUBINSN is the delay slot of INSN, but INSN is
8164 currently unaligned. Insert a nop between
8165 LAST and INSN to align it. */
8166 emit_insn_after (gen_nop (), last);
8167 aligned_p = true;
8170 mips_sim_issue_insn (&state, subinsn);
8172 mips_sim_finish_insn (&state, insn);
8174 /* Update LAST, LAST2 and ALIGNED_P for the next instruction. */
8175 length = get_attr_length (insn);
8176 if (length > 0)
8178 /* If the instruction is an asm statement or multi-instruction
8179 mips.md patern, the length is only an estimate. Insert an
8180 8 byte alignment after it so that the following instructions
8181 can be handled correctly. */
8182 if (NONJUMP_INSN_P (SEQ_BEGIN (insn))
8183 && (recog_memoized (insn) < 0 || length >= 8))
8185 next = emit_insn_after (gen_align (GEN_INT (3)), insn);
8186 next = NEXT_INSN (next);
8187 mips_sim_next_cycle (&state);
8188 aligned_p = true;
8190 else if (length & 4)
8191 aligned_p = !aligned_p;
8192 last2 = last;
8193 last = insn;
8196 /* See whether INSN is an aligned label. */
8197 if (LABEL_P (insn) && label_to_alignment (insn) >= 3)
8198 aligned_p = true;
8200 dfa_finish ();
8203 /* Subroutine of mips_reorg. If there is a hazard between INSN
8204 and a previous instruction, avoid it by inserting nops after
8205 instruction AFTER.
8207 *DELAYED_REG and *HILO_DELAY describe the hazards that apply at
8208 this point. If *DELAYED_REG is non-null, INSN must wait a cycle
8209 before using the value of that register. *HILO_DELAY counts the
8210 number of instructions since the last hilo hazard (that is,
8211 the number of instructions since the last mflo or mfhi).
8213 After inserting nops for INSN, update *DELAYED_REG and *HILO_DELAY
8214 for the next instruction.
8216 LO_REG is an rtx for the LO register, used in dependence checking. */
8218 static void
8219 mips_avoid_hazard (rtx after, rtx insn, int *hilo_delay,
8220 rtx *delayed_reg, rtx lo_reg)
8222 rtx pattern, set;
8223 int nops, ninsns;
8225 if (!INSN_P (insn))
8226 return;
8228 pattern = PATTERN (insn);
8230 /* Do not put the whole function in .set noreorder if it contains
8231 an asm statement. We don't know whether there will be hazards
8232 between the asm statement and the gcc-generated code. */
8233 if (GET_CODE (pattern) == ASM_INPUT || asm_noperands (pattern) >= 0)
8234 cfun->machine->all_noreorder_p = false;
8236 /* Ignore zero-length instructions (barriers and the like). */
8237 ninsns = get_attr_length (insn) / 4;
8238 if (ninsns == 0)
8239 return;
8241 /* Work out how many nops are needed. Note that we only care about
8242 registers that are explicitly mentioned in the instruction's pattern.
8243 It doesn't matter that calls use the argument registers or that they
8244 clobber hi and lo. */
8245 if (*hilo_delay < 2 && reg_set_p (lo_reg, pattern))
8246 nops = 2 - *hilo_delay;
8247 else if (*delayed_reg != 0 && reg_referenced_p (*delayed_reg, pattern))
8248 nops = 1;
8249 else
8250 nops = 0;
8252 /* Insert the nops between this instruction and the previous one.
8253 Each new nop takes us further from the last hilo hazard. */
8254 *hilo_delay += nops;
8255 while (nops-- > 0)
8256 emit_insn_after (gen_hazard_nop (), after);
8258 /* Set up the state for the next instruction. */
8259 *hilo_delay += ninsns;
8260 *delayed_reg = 0;
8261 if (INSN_CODE (insn) >= 0)
8262 switch (get_attr_hazard (insn))
8264 case HAZARD_NONE:
8265 break;
8267 case HAZARD_HILO:
8268 *hilo_delay = 0;
8269 break;
8271 case HAZARD_DELAY:
8272 set = single_set (insn);
8273 gcc_assert (set != 0);
8274 *delayed_reg = SET_DEST (set);
8275 break;
8280 /* Go through the instruction stream and insert nops where necessary.
8281 See if the whole function can then be put into .set noreorder &
8282 .set nomacro. */
8284 static void
8285 mips_avoid_hazards (void)
8287 rtx insn, last_insn, lo_reg, delayed_reg;
8288 int hilo_delay, i;
8290 /* Force all instructions to be split into their final form. */
8291 split_all_insns_noflow ();
8293 /* Recalculate instruction lengths without taking nops into account. */
8294 cfun->machine->ignore_hazard_length_p = true;
8295 shorten_branches (get_insns ());
8297 /* The profiler code uses assembler macros. -mfix-vr4120 relies on
8298 assembler nop insertion. */
8299 cfun->machine->all_noreorder_p = (!current_function_profile
8300 && !TARGET_FIX_VR4120);
8302 last_insn = 0;
8303 hilo_delay = 2;
8304 delayed_reg = 0;
8305 lo_reg = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, LO_REGNUM);
8307 for (insn = get_insns (); insn != 0; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
8308 if (INSN_P (insn))
8310 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
8311 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0); i++)
8312 mips_avoid_hazard (last_insn, XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i),
8313 &hilo_delay, &delayed_reg, lo_reg);
8314 else
8315 mips_avoid_hazard (last_insn, insn, &hilo_delay,
8316 &delayed_reg, lo_reg);
8318 last_insn = insn;
8323 /* Implement TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG. */
8325 static void
8326 mips_reorg (void)
8328 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
8329 mips16_lay_out_constants ();
8330 else if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS)
8332 if (mips_flag_delayed_branch)
8333 dbr_schedule (get_insns (), dump_file);
8334 mips_avoid_hazards ();
8335 if (TUNE_MIPS4130 && TARGET_VR4130_ALIGN)
8336 vr4130_align_insns ();
8340 /* This function does three things:
8342 - Register the special divsi3 and modsi3 functions if -mfix-vr4120.
8343 - Register the mips16 hardware floating point stubs.
8344 - Register the gofast functions if selected using --enable-gofast. */
8346 #include "config/gofast.h"
8348 static void
8349 mips_init_libfuncs (void)
8351 if (TARGET_FIX_VR4120)
8353 set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, SImode, "__vr4120_divsi3");
8354 set_optab_libfunc (smod_optab, SImode, "__vr4120_modsi3");
8357 if (TARGET_MIPS16 && mips16_hard_float)
8359 set_optab_libfunc (add_optab, SFmode, "__mips16_addsf3");
8360 set_optab_libfunc (sub_optab, SFmode, "__mips16_subsf3");
8361 set_optab_libfunc (smul_optab, SFmode, "__mips16_mulsf3");
8362 set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, SFmode, "__mips16_divsf3");
8364 set_optab_libfunc (eq_optab, SFmode, "__mips16_eqsf2");
8365 set_optab_libfunc (ne_optab, SFmode, "__mips16_nesf2");
8366 set_optab_libfunc (gt_optab, SFmode, "__mips16_gtsf2");
8367 set_optab_libfunc (ge_optab, SFmode, "__mips16_gesf2");
8368 set_optab_libfunc (lt_optab, SFmode, "__mips16_ltsf2");
8369 set_optab_libfunc (le_optab, SFmode, "__mips16_lesf2");
8371 set_conv_libfunc (sfix_optab, SImode, SFmode, "__mips16_fix_truncsfsi");
8372 set_conv_libfunc (sfloat_optab, SFmode, SImode, "__mips16_floatsisf");
8374 if (TARGET_DOUBLE_FLOAT)
8376 set_optab_libfunc (add_optab, DFmode, "__mips16_adddf3");
8377 set_optab_libfunc (sub_optab, DFmode, "__mips16_subdf3");
8378 set_optab_libfunc (smul_optab, DFmode, "__mips16_muldf3");
8379 set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, DFmode, "__mips16_divdf3");
8381 set_optab_libfunc (eq_optab, DFmode, "__mips16_eqdf2");
8382 set_optab_libfunc (ne_optab, DFmode, "__mips16_nedf2");
8383 set_optab_libfunc (gt_optab, DFmode, "__mips16_gtdf2");
8384 set_optab_libfunc (ge_optab, DFmode, "__mips16_gedf2");
8385 set_optab_libfunc (lt_optab, DFmode, "__mips16_ltdf2");
8386 set_optab_libfunc (le_optab, DFmode, "__mips16_ledf2");
8388 set_conv_libfunc (sext_optab, DFmode, SFmode, "__mips16_extendsfdf2");
8389 set_conv_libfunc (trunc_optab, SFmode, DFmode, "__mips16_truncdfsf2");
8391 set_conv_libfunc (sfix_optab, SImode, DFmode, "__mips16_fix_truncdfsi");
8392 set_conv_libfunc (sfloat_optab, DFmode, SImode, "__mips16_floatsidf");
8395 else
8396 gofast_maybe_init_libfuncs ();
8399 /* Return a number assessing the cost of moving a register in class
8400 FROM to class TO. The classes are expressed using the enumeration
8401 values such as `GENERAL_REGS'. A value of 2 is the default; other
8402 values are interpreted relative to that.
8404 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when FROM is the
8405 same as TO; on some machines it is expensive to move between
8406 registers if they are not general registers.
8408 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single `set' between two
8409 hard registers, and if `REGISTER_MOVE_COST' applied to their
8410 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that
8411 the constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than
8412 2 will allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You
8413 should do this if the `movM' pattern's constraints do not allow
8414 such copying.
8416 ??? We make the cost of moving from HI/LO into general
8417 registers the same as for one of moving general registers to
8418 HI/LO for TARGET_MIPS16 in order to prevent allocating a
8419 pseudo to HI/LO. This might hurt optimizations though, it
8420 isn't clear if it is wise. And it might not work in all cases. We
8421 could solve the DImode LO reg problem by using a multiply, just
8422 like reload_{in,out}si. We could solve the SImode/HImode HI reg
8423 problem by using divide instructions. divu puts the remainder in
8424 the HI reg, so doing a divide by -1 will move the value in the HI
8425 reg for all values except -1. We could handle that case by using a
8426 signed divide, e.g. -1 / 2 (or maybe 1 / -2?). We'd have to emit
8427 a compare/branch to test the input value to see which instruction
8428 we need to use. This gets pretty messy, but it is feasible. */
8431 mips_register_move_cost (enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8432 enum reg_class to, enum reg_class from)
8434 if (from == M16_REGS && GR_REG_CLASS_P (to))
8435 return 2;
8436 else if (from == M16_NA_REGS && GR_REG_CLASS_P (to))
8437 return 2;
8438 else if (GR_REG_CLASS_P (from))
8440 if (to == M16_REGS)
8441 return 2;
8442 else if (to == M16_NA_REGS)
8443 return 2;
8444 else if (GR_REG_CLASS_P (to))
8446 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
8447 return 4;
8448 else
8449 return 2;
8451 else if (to == FP_REGS)
8452 return 4;
8453 else if (to == HI_REG || to == LO_REG || to == MD_REGS)
8455 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
8456 return 12;
8457 else
8458 return 6;
8460 else if (COP_REG_CLASS_P (to))
8462 return 5;
8464 } /* GR_REG_CLASS_P (from) */
8465 else if (from == FP_REGS)
8467 if (GR_REG_CLASS_P (to))
8468 return 4;
8469 else if (to == FP_REGS)
8470 return 2;
8471 else if (to == ST_REGS)
8472 return 8;
8473 } /* from == FP_REGS */
8474 else if (from == HI_REG || from == LO_REG || from == MD_REGS)
8476 if (GR_REG_CLASS_P (to))
8478 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
8479 return 12;
8480 else
8481 return 6;
8483 } /* from == HI_REG, etc. */
8484 else if (from == ST_REGS && GR_REG_CLASS_P (to))
8485 return 4;
8486 else if (COP_REG_CLASS_P (from))
8488 return 5;
8489 } /* COP_REG_CLASS_P (from) */
8491 /* Fall through. */
8493 return 12;
8496 /* Return the length of INSN. LENGTH is the initial length computed by
8497 attributes in the machine-description file. */
8500 mips_adjust_insn_length (rtx insn, int length)
8502 /* A unconditional jump has an unfilled delay slot if it is not part
8503 of a sequence. A conditional jump normally has a delay slot, but
8504 does not on MIPS16. */
8505 if (CALL_P (insn) || (TARGET_MIPS16 ? simplejump_p (insn) : JUMP_P (insn)))
8506 length += 4;
8508 /* See how many nops might be needed to avoid hardware hazards. */
8509 if (!cfun->machine->ignore_hazard_length_p && INSN_CODE (insn) >= 0)
8510 switch (get_attr_hazard (insn))
8512 case HAZARD_NONE:
8513 break;
8515 case HAZARD_DELAY:
8516 length += 4;
8517 break;
8519 case HAZARD_HILO:
8520 length += 8;
8521 break;
8524 /* All MIPS16 instructions are a measly two bytes. */
8525 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
8526 length /= 2;
8528 return length;
8532 /* Return an asm sequence to start a noat block and load the address
8533 of a label into $1. */
8535 const char *
8536 mips_output_load_label (void)
8538 if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS)
8539 switch (mips_abi)
8541 case ABI_N32:
8542 return "%[lw\t%@,%%got_page(%0)(%+)\n\taddiu\t%@,%@,%%got_ofst(%0)";
8544 case ABI_64:
8545 return "%[ld\t%@,%%got_page(%0)(%+)\n\tdaddiu\t%@,%@,%%got_ofst(%0)";
8547 default:
8548 if (ISA_HAS_LOAD_DELAY)
8549 return "%[lw\t%@,%%got(%0)(%+)%#\n\taddiu\t%@,%@,%%lo(%0)";
8550 return "%[lw\t%@,%%got(%0)(%+)\n\taddiu\t%@,%@,%%lo(%0)";
8552 else
8554 if (Pmode == DImode)
8555 return "%[dla\t%@,%0";
8556 else
8557 return "%[la\t%@,%0";
8562 /* Output assembly instructions to peform a conditional branch.
8564 INSN is the branch instruction. OPERANDS[0] is the condition.
8565 OPERANDS[1] is the target of the branch. OPERANDS[2] is the target
8566 of the first operand to the condition. If TWO_OPERANDS_P is
8567 nonzero the comparison takes two operands; OPERANDS[3] will be the
8568 second operand.
8570 If INVERTED_P is nonzero we are to branch if the condition does
8571 not hold. If FLOAT_P is nonzero this is a floating-point comparison.
8573 LENGTH is the length (in bytes) of the sequence we are to generate.
8574 That tells us whether to generate a simple conditional branch, or a
8575 reversed conditional branch around a `jr' instruction. */
8576 const char *
8577 mips_output_conditional_branch (rtx insn, rtx *operands, int two_operands_p,
8578 int float_p, int inverted_p, int length)
8580 static char buffer[200];
8581 /* The kind of comparison we are doing. */
8582 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (operands[0]);
8583 /* Nonzero if the opcode for the comparison needs a `z' indicating
8584 that it is a comparison against zero. */
8585 int need_z_p;
8586 /* A string to use in the assembly output to represent the first
8587 operand. */
8588 const char *op1 = "%z2";
8589 /* A string to use in the assembly output to represent the second
8590 operand. Use the hard-wired zero register if there's no second
8591 operand. */
8592 const char *op2 = (two_operands_p ? ",%z3" : ",%.");
8593 /* The operand-printing string for the comparison. */
8594 const char *const comp = (float_p ? "%F0" : "%C0");
8595 /* The operand-printing string for the inverted comparison. */
8596 const char *const inverted_comp = (float_p ? "%W0" : "%N0");
8598 /* The MIPS processors (for levels of the ISA at least two), have
8599 "likely" variants of each branch instruction. These instructions
8600 annul the instruction in the delay slot if the branch is not
8601 taken. */
8602 mips_branch_likely = (final_sequence && INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P (insn));
8604 if (!two_operands_p)
8606 /* To compute whether than A > B, for example, we normally
8607 subtract B from A and then look at the sign bit. But, if we
8608 are doing an unsigned comparison, and B is zero, we don't
8609 have to do the subtraction. Instead, we can just check to
8610 see if A is nonzero. Thus, we change the CODE here to
8611 reflect the simpler comparison operation. */
8612 switch (code)
8614 case GTU:
8615 code = NE;
8616 break;
8618 case LEU:
8619 code = EQ;
8620 break;
8622 case GEU:
8623 /* A condition which will always be true. */
8624 code = EQ;
8625 op1 = "%.";
8626 break;
8628 case LTU:
8629 /* A condition which will always be false. */
8630 code = NE;
8631 op1 = "%.";
8632 break;
8634 default:
8635 /* Not a special case. */
8636 break;
8640 /* Relative comparisons are always done against zero. But
8641 equality comparisons are done between two operands, and therefore
8642 do not require a `z' in the assembly language output. */
8643 need_z_p = (!float_p && code != EQ && code != NE);
8644 /* For comparisons against zero, the zero is not provided
8645 explicitly. */
8646 if (need_z_p)
8647 op2 = "";
8649 /* Begin by terminating the buffer. That way we can always use
8650 strcat to add to it. */
8651 buffer[0] = '\0';
8653 switch (length)
8655 case 4:
8656 case 8:
8657 /* Just a simple conditional branch. */
8658 if (float_p)
8659 sprintf (buffer, "%%*b%s%%?\t%%Z2%%1%%/",
8660 inverted_p ? inverted_comp : comp);
8661 else
8662 sprintf (buffer, "%%*b%s%s%%?\t%s%s,%%1%%/",
8663 inverted_p ? inverted_comp : comp,
8664 need_z_p ? "z" : "",
8665 op1,
8666 op2);
8667 return buffer;
8669 case 12:
8670 case 16:
8671 case 24:
8672 case 28:
8674 /* Generate a reversed conditional branch around ` j'
8675 instruction:
8677 .set noreorder
8678 .set nomacro
8679 bc l
8680 delay_slot or #nop
8681 j target
8682 #nop
8684 .set macro
8685 .set reorder
8687 If the original branch was a likely branch, the delay slot
8688 must be executed only if the branch is taken, so generate:
8690 .set noreorder
8691 .set nomacro
8692 bc l
8693 #nop
8694 j target
8695 delay slot or #nop
8697 .set macro
8698 .set reorder
8700 When generating PIC, instead of:
8702 j target
8704 we emit:
8706 .set noat
8707 la $at, target
8708 jr $at
8709 .set at
8712 rtx orig_target;
8713 rtx target = gen_label_rtx ();
8715 orig_target = operands[1];
8716 operands[1] = target;
8717 /* Generate the reversed comparison. This takes four
8718 bytes. */
8719 if (float_p)
8720 sprintf (buffer, "%%*b%s\t%%Z2%%1",
8721 inverted_p ? comp : inverted_comp);
8722 else
8723 sprintf (buffer, "%%*b%s%s\t%s%s,%%1",
8724 inverted_p ? comp : inverted_comp,
8725 need_z_p ? "z" : "",
8726 op1,
8727 op2);
8728 output_asm_insn (buffer, operands);
8730 if (length != 16 && length != 28 && ! mips_branch_likely)
8732 /* Output delay slot instruction. */
8733 rtx insn = final_sequence;
8734 final_scan_insn (XVECEXP (insn, 0, 1), asm_out_file,
8735 optimize, 0, 1, NULL);
8736 INSN_DELETED_P (XVECEXP (insn, 0, 1)) = 1;
8738 else
8739 output_asm_insn ("%#", 0);
8741 if (length <= 16)
8742 output_asm_insn ("j\t%0", &orig_target);
8743 else
8745 output_asm_insn (mips_output_load_label (), &orig_target);
8746 output_asm_insn ("jr\t%@%]", 0);
8749 if (length != 16 && length != 28 && mips_branch_likely)
8751 /* Output delay slot instruction. */
8752 rtx insn = final_sequence;
8753 final_scan_insn (XVECEXP (insn, 0, 1), asm_out_file,
8754 optimize, 0, 1, NULL);
8755 INSN_DELETED_P (XVECEXP (insn, 0, 1)) = 1;
8757 else
8758 output_asm_insn ("%#", 0);
8760 (*targetm.asm_out.internal_label) (asm_out_file, "L",
8761 CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (target));
8763 return "";
8766 default:
8767 gcc_unreachable ();
8770 /* NOTREACHED */
8771 return 0;
8774 /* Used to output div or ddiv instruction DIVISION, which has the operands
8775 given by OPERANDS. Add in a divide-by-zero check if needed.
8777 When working around R4000 and R4400 errata, we need to make sure that
8778 the division is not immediately followed by a shift[1][2]. We also
8779 need to stop the division from being put into a branch delay slot[3].
8780 The easiest way to avoid both problems is to add a nop after the
8781 division. When a divide-by-zero check is needed, this nop can be
8782 used to fill the branch delay slot.
8784 [1] If a double-word or a variable shift executes immediately
8785 after starting an integer division, the shift may give an
8786 incorrect result. See quotations of errata #16 and #28 from
8787 "MIPS R4000PC/SC Errata, Processor Revision 2.2 and 3.0"
8788 in mips.md for details.
8790 [2] A similar bug to [1] exists for all revisions of the
8791 R4000 and the R4400 when run in an MC configuration.
8792 From "MIPS R4000MC Errata, Processor Revision 2.2 and 3.0":
8794 "19. In this following sequence:
8796 ddiv (or ddivu or div or divu)
8797 dsll32 (or dsrl32, dsra32)
8799 if an MPT stall occurs, while the divide is slipping the cpu
8800 pipeline, then the following double shift would end up with an
8801 incorrect result.
8803 Workaround: The compiler needs to avoid generating any
8804 sequence with divide followed by extended double shift."
8806 This erratum is also present in "MIPS R4400MC Errata, Processor
8807 Revision 1.0" and "MIPS R4400MC Errata, Processor Revision 2.0
8808 & 3.0" as errata #10 and #4, respectively.
8810 [3] From "MIPS R4000PC/SC Errata, Processor Revision 2.2 and 3.0"
8811 (also valid for MIPS R4000MC processors):
8813 "52. R4000SC: This bug does not apply for the R4000PC.
8815 There are two flavors of this bug:
8817 1) If the instruction just after divide takes an RF exception
8818 (tlb-refill, tlb-invalid) and gets an instruction cache
8819 miss (both primary and secondary) and the line which is
8820 currently in secondary cache at this index had the first
8821 data word, where the bits 5..2 are set, then R4000 would
8822 get a wrong result for the div.
8826 div r8, r9
8827 ------------------- # end-of page. -tlb-refill
8831 div r8, r9
8832 ------------------- # end-of page. -tlb-invalid
8835 2) If the divide is in the taken branch delay slot, where the
8836 target takes RF exception and gets an I-cache miss for the
8837 exception vector or where I-cache miss occurs for the
8838 target address, under the above mentioned scenarios, the
8839 div would get wrong results.
8842 j r2 # to next page mapped or unmapped
8843 div r8,r9 # this bug would be there as long
8844 # as there is an ICache miss and
8845 nop # the "data pattern" is present
8848 beq r0, r0, NextPage # to Next page
8849 div r8,r9
8852 This bug is present for div, divu, ddiv, and ddivu
8853 instructions.
8855 Workaround: For item 1), OS could make sure that the next page
8856 after the divide instruction is also mapped. For item 2), the
8857 compiler could make sure that the divide instruction is not in
8858 the branch delay slot."
8860 These processors have PRId values of 0x00004220 and 0x00004300 for
8861 the R4000 and 0x00004400, 0x00004500 and 0x00004600 for the R4400. */
8863 const char *
8864 mips_output_division (const char *division, rtx *operands)
8866 const char *s;
8868 s = division;
8869 if (TARGET_FIX_R4000 || TARGET_FIX_R4400)
8871 output_asm_insn (s, operands);
8872 s = "nop";
8874 if (TARGET_CHECK_ZERO_DIV)
8876 if (TARGET_MIPS16)
8878 output_asm_insn (s, operands);
8879 s = "bnez\t%2,1f\n\tbreak\t7\n1:";
8881 else if (GENERATE_DIVIDE_TRAPS)
8883 output_asm_insn (s, operands);
8884 s = "teq\t%2,%.,7";
8886 else
8888 output_asm_insn ("%(bne\t%2,%.,1f", operands);
8889 output_asm_insn (s, operands);
8890 s = "break\t7%)\n1:";
8893 return s;
8896 /* Return true if GIVEN is the same as CANONICAL, or if it is CANONICAL
8897 with a final "000" replaced by "k". Ignore case.
8899 Note: this function is shared between GCC and GAS. */
8901 static bool
8902 mips_strict_matching_cpu_name_p (const char *canonical, const char *given)
8904 while (*given != 0 && TOLOWER (*given) == TOLOWER (*canonical))
8905 given++, canonical++;
8907 return ((*given == 0 && *canonical == 0)
8908 || (strcmp (canonical, "000") == 0 && strcasecmp (given, "k") == 0));
8912 /* Return true if GIVEN matches CANONICAL, where GIVEN is a user-supplied
8913 CPU name. We've traditionally allowed a lot of variation here.
8915 Note: this function is shared between GCC and GAS. */
8917 static bool
8918 mips_matching_cpu_name_p (const char *canonical, const char *given)
8920 /* First see if the name matches exactly, or with a final "000"
8921 turned into "k". */
8922 if (mips_strict_matching_cpu_name_p (canonical, given))
8923 return true;
8925 /* If not, try comparing based on numerical designation alone.
8926 See if GIVEN is an unadorned number, or 'r' followed by a number. */
8927 if (TOLOWER (*given) == 'r')
8928 given++;
8929 if (!ISDIGIT (*given))
8930 return false;
8932 /* Skip over some well-known prefixes in the canonical name,
8933 hoping to find a number there too. */
8934 if (TOLOWER (canonical[0]) == 'v' && TOLOWER (canonical[1]) == 'r')
8935 canonical += 2;
8936 else if (TOLOWER (canonical[0]) == 'r' && TOLOWER (canonical[1]) == 'm')
8937 canonical += 2;
8938 else if (TOLOWER (canonical[0]) == 'r')
8939 canonical += 1;
8941 return mips_strict_matching_cpu_name_p (canonical, given);
8945 /* Parse an option that takes the name of a processor as its argument.
8946 OPTION is the name of the option and CPU_STRING is the argument.
8947 Return the corresponding processor enumeration if the CPU_STRING is
8948 recognized, otherwise report an error and return null.
8950 A similar function exists in GAS. */
8952 static const struct mips_cpu_info *
8953 mips_parse_cpu (const char *option, const char *cpu_string)
8955 const struct mips_cpu_info *p;
8956 const char *s;
8958 /* In the past, we allowed upper-case CPU names, but it doesn't
8959 work well with the multilib machinery. */
8960 for (s = cpu_string; *s != 0; s++)
8961 if (ISUPPER (*s))
8963 warning ("the cpu name must be lower case");
8964 break;
8967 /* 'from-abi' selects the most compatible architecture for the given
8968 ABI: MIPS I for 32-bit ABIs and MIPS III for 64-bit ABIs. For the
8969 EABIs, we have to decide whether we're using the 32-bit or 64-bit
8970 version. Look first at the -mgp options, if given, otherwise base
8971 the choice on MASK_64BIT in TARGET_DEFAULT. */
8972 if (strcasecmp (cpu_string, "from-abi") == 0)
8973 return mips_cpu_info_from_isa (ABI_NEEDS_32BIT_REGS ? 1
8974 : ABI_NEEDS_64BIT_REGS ? 3
8975 : (TARGET_64BIT ? 3 : 1));
8977 /* 'default' has traditionally been a no-op. Probably not very useful. */
8978 if (strcasecmp (cpu_string, "default") == 0)
8979 return 0;
8981 for (p = mips_cpu_info_table; p->name != 0; p++)
8982 if (mips_matching_cpu_name_p (p->name, cpu_string))
8983 return p;
8985 error ("bad value (%s) for %s", cpu_string, option);
8986 return 0;
8990 /* Return the processor associated with the given ISA level, or null
8991 if the ISA isn't valid. */
8993 static const struct mips_cpu_info *
8994 mips_cpu_info_from_isa (int isa)
8996 const struct mips_cpu_info *p;
8998 for (p = mips_cpu_info_table; p->name != 0; p++)
8999 if (p->isa == isa)
9000 return p;
9002 return 0;
9005 /* Implement HARD_REGNO_NREGS. The size of FP registers is controlled
9006 by UNITS_PER_FPREG. The size of FP status registers is always 4, because
9007 they only hold condition code modes, and CCmode is always considered to
9008 be 4 bytes wide. All other registers are word sized. */
9010 unsigned int
9011 mips_hard_regno_nregs (int regno, enum machine_mode mode)
9013 if (ST_REG_P (regno))
9014 return ((GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + 3) / 4);
9015 else if (! FP_REG_P (regno))
9016 return ((GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD);
9017 else
9018 return ((GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + UNITS_PER_FPREG - 1) / UNITS_PER_FPREG);
9021 /* Implement TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY. Under the old (i.e., 32 and O64 ABIs)
9022 all BLKmode objects are returned in memory. Under the new (N32 and
9023 64-bit MIPS ABIs) small structures are returned in a register.
9024 Objects with varying size must still be returned in memory, of
9025 course. */
9027 static bool
9028 mips_return_in_memory (tree type, tree fndecl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9030 if (TARGET_OLDABI)
9031 return (TYPE_MODE (type) == BLKmode);
9032 else
9033 return ((int_size_in_bytes (type) > (2 * UNITS_PER_WORD))
9034 || (int_size_in_bytes (type) == -1));
9037 static bool
9038 mips_strict_argument_naming (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *ca ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9040 return !TARGET_OLDABI;
9043 /* Return true if INSN is a multiply-add or multiply-subtract
9044 instruction and PREV assigns to the accumulator operand. */
9046 bool
9047 mips_linked_madd_p (rtx prev, rtx insn)
9049 rtx x;
9051 x = single_set (insn);
9052 if (x == 0)
9053 return false;
9055 x = SET_SRC (x);
9057 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
9058 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == MULT
9059 && reg_set_p (XEXP (x, 1), prev))
9060 return true;
9062 if (GET_CODE (x) == MINUS
9063 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == MULT
9064 && reg_set_p (XEXP (x, 0), prev))
9065 return true;
9067 return false;
9070 /* Used by TUNE_MACC_CHAINS to record the last scheduled instruction
9071 that may clobber hi or lo. */
9073 static rtx mips_macc_chains_last_hilo;
9075 /* A TUNE_MACC_CHAINS helper function. Record that instruction INSN has
9076 been scheduled, updating mips_macc_chains_last_hilo appropriately. */
9078 static void
9079 mips_macc_chains_record (rtx insn)
9081 if (get_attr_may_clobber_hilo (insn))
9082 mips_macc_chains_last_hilo = insn;
9085 /* A TUNE_MACC_CHAINS helper function. Search ready queue READY, which
9086 has NREADY elements, looking for a multiply-add or multiply-subtract
9087 instruction that is cumulative with mips_macc_chains_last_hilo.
9088 If there is one, promote it ahead of anything else that might
9089 clobber hi or lo. */
9091 static void
9092 mips_macc_chains_reorder (rtx *ready, int nready)
9094 int i, j;
9096 if (mips_macc_chains_last_hilo != 0)
9097 for (i = nready - 1; i >= 0; i--)
9098 if (mips_linked_madd_p (mips_macc_chains_last_hilo, ready[i]))
9100 for (j = nready - 1; j > i; j--)
9101 if (recog_memoized (ready[j]) >= 0
9102 && get_attr_may_clobber_hilo (ready[j]))
9104 mips_promote_ready (ready, i, j);
9105 break;
9107 break;
9111 /* The last instruction to be scheduled. */
9113 static rtx vr4130_last_insn;
9115 /* A note_stores callback used by vr4130_true_reg_dependence_p. DATA
9116 points to an rtx that is initially an instruction. Nullify the rtx
9117 if the instruction uses the value of register X. */
9119 static void
9120 vr4130_true_reg_dependence_p_1 (rtx x, rtx pat ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *data)
9122 rtx *insn_ptr = data;
9123 if (REG_P (x)
9124 && *insn_ptr != 0
9125 && reg_referenced_p (x, PATTERN (*insn_ptr)))
9126 *insn_ptr = 0;
9129 /* Return true if there is true register dependence between vr4130_last_insn
9130 and INSN. */
9132 static bool
9133 vr4130_true_reg_dependence_p (rtx insn)
9135 note_stores (PATTERN (vr4130_last_insn),
9136 vr4130_true_reg_dependence_p_1, &insn);
9137 return insn == 0;
9140 /* A TUNE_MIPS4130 helper function. Given that INSN1 is at the head of
9141 the ready queue and that INSN2 is the instruction after it, return
9142 true if it is worth promoting INSN2 ahead of INSN1. Look for cases
9143 in which INSN1 and INSN2 can probably issue in parallel, but for
9144 which (INSN2, INSN1) should be less sensitive to instruction
9145 alignment than (INSN1, INSN2). See 4130.md for more details. */
9147 static bool
9148 vr4130_swap_insns_p (rtx insn1, rtx insn2)
9150 rtx dep;
9152 /* Check for the following case:
9154 1) there is some other instruction X with an anti dependence on INSN1;
9155 2) X has a higher priority than INSN2; and
9156 3) X is an arithmetic instruction (and thus has no unit restrictions).
9158 If INSN1 is the last instruction blocking X, it would better to
9159 choose (INSN1, X) over (INSN2, INSN1). */
9160 for (dep = INSN_DEPEND (insn1); dep != 0; dep = XEXP (dep, 1))
9161 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (dep) == REG_DEP_ANTI
9162 && INSN_PRIORITY (XEXP (dep, 0)) > INSN_PRIORITY (insn2)
9163 && recog_memoized (XEXP (dep, 0)) >= 0
9164 && get_attr_vr4130_class (XEXP (dep, 0)) == VR4130_CLASS_ALU)
9165 return false;
9167 if (vr4130_last_insn != 0
9168 && recog_memoized (insn1) >= 0
9169 && recog_memoized (insn2) >= 0)
9171 /* See whether INSN1 and INSN2 use different execution units,
9172 or if they are both ALU-type instructions. If so, they can
9173 probably execute in parallel. */
9174 enum attr_vr4130_class class1 = get_attr_vr4130_class (insn1);
9175 enum attr_vr4130_class class2 = get_attr_vr4130_class (insn2);
9176 if (class1 != class2 || class1 == VR4130_CLASS_ALU)
9178 /* If only one of the instructions has a dependence on
9179 vr4130_last_insn, prefer to schedule the other one first. */
9180 bool dep1 = vr4130_true_reg_dependence_p (insn1);
9181 bool dep2 = vr4130_true_reg_dependence_p (insn2);
9182 if (dep1 != dep2)
9183 return dep1;
9185 /* Prefer to schedule INSN2 ahead of INSN1 if vr4130_last_insn
9186 is not an ALU-type instruction and if INSN1 uses the same
9187 execution unit. (Note that if this condition holds, we already
9188 know that INSN2 uses a different execution unit.) */
9189 if (class1 != VR4130_CLASS_ALU
9190 && recog_memoized (vr4130_last_insn) >= 0
9191 && class1 == get_attr_vr4130_class (vr4130_last_insn))
9192 return true;
9195 return false;
9198 /* A TUNE_MIPS4130 helper function. (READY, NREADY) describes a ready
9199 queue with at least two instructions. Swap the first two if
9200 vr4130_swap_insns_p says that it could be worthwhile. */
9202 static void
9203 vr4130_reorder (rtx *ready, int nready)
9205 if (vr4130_swap_insns_p (ready[nready - 1], ready[nready - 2]))
9206 mips_promote_ready (ready, nready - 2, nready - 1);
9209 /* Remove the instruction at index LOWER from ready queue READY and
9210 reinsert it in front of the instruction at index HIGHER. LOWER must
9211 be <= HIGHER. */
9213 static void
9214 mips_promote_ready (rtx *ready, int lower, int higher)
9216 rtx new_head;
9217 int i;
9219 new_head = ready[lower];
9220 for (i = lower; i < higher; i++)
9221 ready[i] = ready[i + 1];
9222 ready[i] = new_head;
9225 /* Implement TARGET_SCHED_REORDER. */
9227 static int
9228 mips_sched_reorder (FILE *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, int verbose ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9229 rtx *ready, int *nreadyp, int cycle)
9231 if (!reload_completed && TUNE_MACC_CHAINS)
9233 if (cycle == 0)
9234 mips_macc_chains_last_hilo = 0;
9235 if (*nreadyp > 0)
9236 mips_macc_chains_reorder (ready, *nreadyp);
9238 if (reload_completed && TUNE_MIPS4130 && !TARGET_VR4130_ALIGN)
9240 if (cycle == 0)
9241 vr4130_last_insn = 0;
9242 if (*nreadyp > 1)
9243 vr4130_reorder (ready, *nreadyp);
9245 return mips_issue_rate ();
9248 /* Implement TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE. */
9250 static int
9251 mips_variable_issue (FILE *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, int verbose ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9252 rtx insn, int more)
9254 switch (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)))
9256 case USE:
9257 case CLOBBER:
9258 /* Don't count USEs and CLOBBERs against the issue rate. */
9259 break;
9261 default:
9262 more--;
9263 if (!reload_completed && TUNE_MACC_CHAINS)
9264 mips_macc_chains_record (insn);
9265 vr4130_last_insn = insn;
9266 break;
9268 return more;
9271 /* Implement TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST. We assume that anti and output
9272 dependencies have no cost. */
9274 static int
9275 mips_adjust_cost (rtx insn ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, rtx link,
9276 rtx dep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, int cost)
9278 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (link) != 0)
9279 return 0;
9280 return cost;
9283 /* Return the number of instructions that can be issued per cycle. */
9285 static int
9286 mips_issue_rate (void)
9288 switch (mips_tune)
9290 case PROCESSOR_R4130:
9291 case PROCESSOR_R5400:
9292 case PROCESSOR_R5500:
9293 case PROCESSOR_R7000:
9294 case PROCESSOR_R9000:
9295 return 2;
9297 case PROCESSOR_SB1:
9298 /* This is actually 4, but we get better performance if we claim 3.
9299 This is partly because of unwanted speculative code motion with the
9300 larger number, and partly because in most common cases we can't
9301 reach the theoretical max of 4. */
9302 return 3;
9304 default:
9305 return 1;
9309 /* Implements TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD. This should
9310 be as wide as the scheduling freedom in the DFA. */
9312 static int
9313 mips_multipass_dfa_lookahead (void)
9315 /* Can schedule up to 4 of the 6 function units in any one cycle. */
9316 if (mips_tune == PROCESSOR_SB1)
9317 return 4;
9319 return 0;
9322 /* Given that we have an rtx of the form (prefetch ... WRITE LOCALITY),
9323 return the first operand of the associated "pref" or "prefx" insn. */
9326 mips_prefetch_cookie (rtx write, rtx locality)
9328 /* store_streamed / load_streamed. */
9329 if (INTVAL (locality) <= 0)
9330 return GEN_INT (INTVAL (write) + 4);
9332 /* store / load. */
9333 if (INTVAL (locality) <= 2)
9334 return write;
9336 /* store_retained / load_retained. */
9337 return GEN_INT (INTVAL (write) + 6);
9340 /* MIPS builtin function support. */
9342 struct builtin_description
9344 /* The code of the main .md file instruction. See mips_builtin_type
9345 for more information. */
9346 enum insn_code icode;
9348 /* The floating-point comparison code to use with ICODE, if any. */
9349 enum mips_fp_condition cond;
9351 /* The name of the builtin function. */
9352 const char *name;
9354 /* Specifies how the function should be expanded. */
9355 enum mips_builtin_type builtin_type;
9357 /* The function's prototype. */
9358 enum mips_function_type function_type;
9360 /* The target flags required for this function. */
9361 int target_flags;
9364 /* Define a MIPS_BUILTIN_DIRECT function for instruction CODE_FOR_mips_<INSN>.
9365 FUNCTION_TYPE and TARGET_FLAGS are builtin_description fields. */
9366 #define DIRECT_BUILTIN(INSN, FUNCTION_TYPE, TARGET_FLAGS) \
9367 { CODE_FOR_mips_ ## INSN, 0, "__builtin_mips_" #INSN, \
9368 MIPS_BUILTIN_DIRECT, FUNCTION_TYPE, TARGET_FLAGS }
9370 /* Define __builtin_mips_<INSN>_<COND>_{s,d}, both of which require
9371 TARGET_FLAGS. */
9372 #define CMP_SCALAR_BUILTINS(INSN, COND, TARGET_FLAGS) \
9373 { CODE_FOR_mips_ ## INSN ## _cond_s, MIPS_FP_COND_ ## COND, \
9374 "__builtin_mips_" #INSN "_" #COND "_s", \
9375 MIPS_BUILTIN_CMP_SINGLE, MIPS_INT_FTYPE_SF_SF, TARGET_FLAGS }, \
9376 { CODE_FOR_mips_ ## INSN ## _cond_d, MIPS_FP_COND_ ## COND, \
9377 "__builtin_mips_" #INSN "_" #COND "_d", \
9378 MIPS_BUILTIN_CMP_SINGLE, MIPS_INT_FTYPE_DF_DF, TARGET_FLAGS }
9380 /* Define __builtin_mips_{any,all,upper,lower}_<INSN>_<COND>_ps.
9381 The lower and upper forms require TARGET_FLAGS while the any and all
9382 forms require MASK_MIPS3D. */
9383 #define CMP_PS_BUILTINS(INSN, COND, TARGET_FLAGS) \
9384 { CODE_FOR_mips_ ## INSN ## _cond_ps, MIPS_FP_COND_ ## COND, \
9385 "__builtin_mips_any_" #INSN "_" #COND "_ps", \
9386 MIPS_BUILTIN_CMP_ANY, MIPS_INT_FTYPE_V2SF_V2SF, MASK_MIPS3D }, \
9387 { CODE_FOR_mips_ ## INSN ## _cond_ps, MIPS_FP_COND_ ## COND, \
9388 "__builtin_mips_all_" #INSN "_" #COND "_ps", \
9389 MIPS_BUILTIN_CMP_ALL, MIPS_INT_FTYPE_V2SF_V2SF, MASK_MIPS3D }, \
9390 { CODE_FOR_mips_ ## INSN ## _cond_ps, MIPS_FP_COND_ ## COND, \
9391 "__builtin_mips_lower_" #INSN "_" #COND "_ps", \
9392 MIPS_BUILTIN_CMP_LOWER, MIPS_INT_FTYPE_V2SF_V2SF, TARGET_FLAGS }, \
9393 { CODE_FOR_mips_ ## INSN ## _cond_ps, MIPS_FP_COND_ ## COND, \
9394 "__builtin_mips_upper_" #INSN "_" #COND "_ps", \
9395 MIPS_BUILTIN_CMP_UPPER, MIPS_INT_FTYPE_V2SF_V2SF, TARGET_FLAGS }
9397 /* Define __builtin_mips_{any,all}_<INSN>_<COND>_4s. The functions
9398 require MASK_MIPS3D. */
9399 #define CMP_4S_BUILTINS(INSN, COND) \
9400 { CODE_FOR_mips_ ## INSN ## _cond_4s, MIPS_FP_COND_ ## COND, \
9401 "__builtin_mips_any_" #INSN "_" #COND "_4s", \
9402 MIPS_BUILTIN_CMP_ANY, MIPS_INT_FTYPE_V2SF_V2SF_V2SF_V2SF, \
9403 MASK_MIPS3D }, \
9404 { CODE_FOR_mips_ ## INSN ## _cond_4s, MIPS_FP_COND_ ## COND, \
9405 "__builtin_mips_all_" #INSN "_" #COND "_4s", \
9406 MIPS_BUILTIN_CMP_ALL, MIPS_INT_FTYPE_V2SF_V2SF_V2SF_V2SF, \
9407 MASK_MIPS3D }
9409 /* Define __builtin_mips_mov{t,f}_<INSN>_<COND>_ps. The comparison
9410 instruction requires TARGET_FLAGS. */
9411 #define MOVTF_BUILTINS(INSN, COND, TARGET_FLAGS) \
9412 { CODE_FOR_mips_ ## INSN ## _cond_ps, MIPS_FP_COND_ ## COND, \
9413 "__builtin_mips_movt_" #INSN "_" #COND "_ps", \
9414 MIPS_BUILTIN_MOVT, MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_V2SF_V2SF_V2SF_V2SF, \
9415 TARGET_FLAGS }, \
9416 { CODE_FOR_mips_ ## INSN ## _cond_ps, MIPS_FP_COND_ ## COND, \
9417 "__builtin_mips_movf_" #INSN "_" #COND "_ps", \
9418 MIPS_BUILTIN_MOVF, MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_V2SF_V2SF_V2SF_V2SF, \
9419 TARGET_FLAGS }
9421 /* Define all the builtins related to c.cond.fmt condition COND. */
9422 #define CMP_BUILTINS(COND) \
9423 MOVTF_BUILTINS (c, COND, MASK_PAIRED_SINGLE), \
9424 MOVTF_BUILTINS (cabs, COND, MASK_MIPS3D), \
9425 CMP_SCALAR_BUILTINS (cabs, COND, MASK_MIPS3D), \
9426 CMP_PS_BUILTINS (c, COND, MASK_PAIRED_SINGLE), \
9427 CMP_PS_BUILTINS (cabs, COND, MASK_MIPS3D), \
9428 CMP_4S_BUILTINS (c, COND), \
9429 CMP_4S_BUILTINS (cabs, COND)
9431 /* __builtin_mips_abs_ps() maps to the standard absM2 pattern. */
9432 #define CODE_FOR_mips_abs_ps CODE_FOR_absv2sf2
9434 static const struct builtin_description mips_bdesc[] =
9436 DIRECT_BUILTIN (pll_ps, MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_V2SF_V2SF, MASK_PAIRED_SINGLE),
9437 DIRECT_BUILTIN (pul_ps, MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_V2SF_V2SF, MASK_PAIRED_SINGLE),
9438 DIRECT_BUILTIN (plu_ps, MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_V2SF_V2SF, MASK_PAIRED_SINGLE),
9439 DIRECT_BUILTIN (puu_ps, MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_V2SF_V2SF, MASK_PAIRED_SINGLE),
9440 DIRECT_BUILTIN (cvt_ps_s, MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_SF_SF, MASK_PAIRED_SINGLE),
9441 DIRECT_BUILTIN (cvt_s_pl, MIPS_SF_FTYPE_V2SF, MASK_PAIRED_SINGLE),
9442 DIRECT_BUILTIN (cvt_s_pu, MIPS_SF_FTYPE_V2SF, MASK_PAIRED_SINGLE),
9443 DIRECT_BUILTIN (abs_ps, MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_V2SF, MASK_PAIRED_SINGLE),
9445 DIRECT_BUILTIN (alnv_ps, MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_V2SF_V2SF_INT, MASK_PAIRED_SINGLE),
9446 DIRECT_BUILTIN (addr_ps, MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_V2SF_V2SF, MASK_MIPS3D),
9447 DIRECT_BUILTIN (mulr_ps, MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_V2SF_V2SF, MASK_MIPS3D),
9448 DIRECT_BUILTIN (cvt_pw_ps, MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_V2SF, MASK_MIPS3D),
9449 DIRECT_BUILTIN (cvt_ps_pw, MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_V2SF, MASK_MIPS3D),
9451 DIRECT_BUILTIN (recip1_s, MIPS_SF_FTYPE_SF, MASK_MIPS3D),
9452 DIRECT_BUILTIN (recip1_d, MIPS_DF_FTYPE_DF, MASK_MIPS3D),
9453 DIRECT_BUILTIN (recip1_ps, MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_V2SF, MASK_MIPS3D),
9454 DIRECT_BUILTIN (recip2_s, MIPS_SF_FTYPE_SF_SF, MASK_MIPS3D),
9455 DIRECT_BUILTIN (recip2_d, MIPS_DF_FTYPE_DF_DF, MASK_MIPS3D),
9456 DIRECT_BUILTIN (recip2_ps, MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_V2SF_V2SF, MASK_MIPS3D),
9458 DIRECT_BUILTIN (rsqrt1_s, MIPS_SF_FTYPE_SF, MASK_MIPS3D),
9459 DIRECT_BUILTIN (rsqrt1_d, MIPS_DF_FTYPE_DF, MASK_MIPS3D),
9460 DIRECT_BUILTIN (rsqrt1_ps, MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_V2SF, MASK_MIPS3D),
9461 DIRECT_BUILTIN (rsqrt2_s, MIPS_SF_FTYPE_SF_SF, MASK_MIPS3D),
9462 DIRECT_BUILTIN (rsqrt2_d, MIPS_DF_FTYPE_DF_DF, MASK_MIPS3D),
9463 DIRECT_BUILTIN (rsqrt2_ps, MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_V2SF_V2SF, MASK_MIPS3D),
9465 MIPS_FP_CONDITIONS (CMP_BUILTINS)
9468 /* Builtin functions for the SB-1 processor. */
9470 #define CODE_FOR_mips_sqrt_ps CODE_FOR_sqrtv2sf2
9472 static const struct builtin_description sb1_bdesc[] =
9474 DIRECT_BUILTIN (sqrt_ps, MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_V2SF, MASK_PAIRED_SINGLE)
9477 /* This helps provide a mapping from builtin function codes to bdesc
9478 arrays. */
9480 struct bdesc_map
9482 /* The builtin function table that this entry describes. */
9483 const struct builtin_description *bdesc;
9485 /* The number of entries in the builtin function table. */
9486 unsigned int size;
9488 /* The target processor that supports these builtin functions.
9489 PROCESSOR_DEFAULT means we enable them for all processors. */
9490 enum processor_type proc;
9493 static const struct bdesc_map bdesc_arrays[] =
9495 { mips_bdesc, ARRAY_SIZE (mips_bdesc), PROCESSOR_DEFAULT },
9496 { sb1_bdesc, ARRAY_SIZE (sb1_bdesc), PROCESSOR_SB1 }
9499 /* Take the head of argument list *ARGLIST and convert it into a form
9500 suitable for input operand OP of instruction ICODE. Return the value
9501 and point *ARGLIST at the next element of the list. */
9503 static rtx
9504 mips_prepare_builtin_arg (enum insn_code icode,
9505 unsigned int op, tree *arglist)
9507 rtx value;
9508 enum machine_mode mode;
9510 value = expand_expr (TREE_VALUE (*arglist), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
9511 mode = insn_data[icode].operand[op].mode;
9512 if (!insn_data[icode].operand[op].predicate (value, mode))
9513 value = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, value);
9515 *arglist = TREE_CHAIN (*arglist);
9516 return value;
9519 /* Return an rtx suitable for output operand OP of instruction ICODE.
9520 If TARGET is non-null, try to use it where possible. */
9522 static rtx
9523 mips_prepare_builtin_target (enum insn_code icode, unsigned int op, rtx target)
9525 enum machine_mode mode;
9527 mode = insn_data[icode].operand[op].mode;
9528 if (target == 0 || !insn_data[icode].operand[op].predicate (target, mode))
9529 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
9531 return target;
9534 /* Expand builtin functions. This is called from TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN. */
9537 mips_expand_builtin (tree exp, rtx target, rtx subtarget ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9538 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9539 int ignore ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9541 enum insn_code icode;
9542 enum mips_builtin_type type;
9543 tree fndecl, arglist;
9544 unsigned int fcode;
9545 const struct builtin_description *bdesc;
9546 const struct bdesc_map *m;
9548 fndecl = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
9549 arglist = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
9550 fcode = DECL_FUNCTION_CODE (fndecl);
9552 bdesc = NULL;
9553 for (m = bdesc_arrays; m < &bdesc_arrays[ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_arrays)]; m++)
9555 if (fcode < m->size)
9557 bdesc = m->bdesc;
9558 icode = bdesc[fcode].icode;
9559 type = bdesc[fcode].builtin_type;
9560 break;
9562 fcode -= m->size;
9564 if (bdesc == NULL)
9565 return 0;
9567 switch (type)
9569 case MIPS_BUILTIN_DIRECT:
9570 return mips_expand_builtin_direct (icode, target, arglist);
9572 case MIPS_BUILTIN_MOVT:
9573 case MIPS_BUILTIN_MOVF:
9574 return mips_expand_builtin_movtf (type, icode, bdesc[fcode].cond,
9575 target, arglist);
9577 case MIPS_BUILTIN_CMP_ANY:
9578 case MIPS_BUILTIN_CMP_ALL:
9579 case MIPS_BUILTIN_CMP_UPPER:
9580 case MIPS_BUILTIN_CMP_LOWER:
9581 case MIPS_BUILTIN_CMP_SINGLE:
9582 return mips_expand_builtin_compare (type, icode, bdesc[fcode].cond,
9583 target, arglist);
9585 default:
9586 return 0;
9590 /* Init builtin functions. This is called from TARGET_INIT_BUILTIN. */
9592 void
9593 mips_init_builtins (void)
9595 const struct builtin_description *d;
9596 const struct bdesc_map *m;
9597 tree types[(int) MIPS_MAX_FTYPE_MAX];
9598 tree V2SF_type_node;
9599 unsigned int offset;
9601 /* We have only builtins for -mpaired-single and -mips3d. */
9602 if (!TARGET_PAIRED_SINGLE_FLOAT)
9603 return;
9605 V2SF_type_node = build_vector_type_for_mode (float_type_node, V2SFmode);
9607 types[MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_V2SF]
9608 = build_function_type_list (V2SF_type_node, V2SF_type_node, NULL_TREE);
9610 types[MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_V2SF_V2SF]
9611 = build_function_type_list (V2SF_type_node,
9612 V2SF_type_node, V2SF_type_node, NULL_TREE);
9614 types[MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_V2SF_V2SF_INT]
9615 = build_function_type_list (V2SF_type_node,
9616 V2SF_type_node, V2SF_type_node,
9617 integer_type_node, NULL_TREE);
9619 types[MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_V2SF_V2SF_V2SF_V2SF]
9620 = build_function_type_list (V2SF_type_node,
9621 V2SF_type_node, V2SF_type_node,
9622 V2SF_type_node, V2SF_type_node, NULL_TREE);
9624 types[MIPS_V2SF_FTYPE_SF_SF]
9625 = build_function_type_list (V2SF_type_node,
9626 float_type_node, float_type_node, NULL_TREE);
9628 types[MIPS_INT_FTYPE_V2SF_V2SF]
9629 = build_function_type_list (integer_type_node,
9630 V2SF_type_node, V2SF_type_node, NULL_TREE);
9632 types[MIPS_INT_FTYPE_V2SF_V2SF_V2SF_V2SF]
9633 = build_function_type_list (integer_type_node,
9634 V2SF_type_node, V2SF_type_node,
9635 V2SF_type_node, V2SF_type_node, NULL_TREE);
9637 types[MIPS_INT_FTYPE_SF_SF]
9638 = build_function_type_list (integer_type_node,
9639 float_type_node, float_type_node, NULL_TREE);
9641 types[MIPS_INT_FTYPE_DF_DF]
9642 = build_function_type_list (integer_type_node,
9643 double_type_node, double_type_node, NULL_TREE);
9645 types[MIPS_SF_FTYPE_V2SF]
9646 = build_function_type_list (float_type_node, V2SF_type_node, NULL_TREE);
9648 types[MIPS_SF_FTYPE_SF]
9649 = build_function_type_list (float_type_node,
9650 float_type_node, NULL_TREE);
9652 types[MIPS_SF_FTYPE_SF_SF]
9653 = build_function_type_list (float_type_node,
9654 float_type_node, float_type_node, NULL_TREE);
9656 types[MIPS_DF_FTYPE_DF]
9657 = build_function_type_list (double_type_node,
9658 double_type_node, NULL_TREE);
9660 types[MIPS_DF_FTYPE_DF_DF]
9661 = build_function_type_list (double_type_node,
9662 double_type_node, double_type_node, NULL_TREE);
9664 /* Iterate through all of the bdesc arrays, initializing all of the
9665 builtin functions. */
9667 offset = 0;
9668 for (m = bdesc_arrays; m < &bdesc_arrays[ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_arrays)]; m++)
9670 if (m->proc == PROCESSOR_DEFAULT || (m->proc == mips_arch))
9671 for (d = m->bdesc; d < &m->bdesc[m->size]; d++)
9672 if ((d->target_flags & target_flags) == d->target_flags)
9673 lang_hooks.builtin_function (d->name, types[d->function_type],
9674 d - m->bdesc + offset,
9675 BUILT_IN_MD, NULL, NULL);
9676 offset += m->size;
9680 /* Expand a MIPS_BUILTIN_DIRECT function. ICODE is the code of the
9681 .md pattern and ARGLIST is the list of function arguments. TARGET,
9682 if nonnull, suggests a good place to put the result. */
9684 static rtx
9685 mips_expand_builtin_direct (enum insn_code icode, rtx target, tree arglist)
9687 rtx ops[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
9688 int i;
9690 target = mips_prepare_builtin_target (icode, 0, target);
9691 for (i = 1; i < insn_data[icode].n_operands; i++)
9692 ops[i] = mips_prepare_builtin_arg (icode, i, &arglist);
9694 switch (insn_data[icode].n_operands)
9696 case 2:
9697 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode) (target, ops[1]));
9698 break;
9700 case 3:
9701 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode) (target, ops[1], ops[2]));
9702 break;
9704 case 4:
9705 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode) (target, ops[1], ops[2], ops[3]));
9706 break;
9708 default:
9709 gcc_unreachable ();
9711 return target;
9714 /* Expand a __builtin_mips_movt_*_ps() or __builtin_mips_movf_*_ps()
9715 function (TYPE says which). ARGLIST is the list of arguments to the
9716 function, ICODE is the instruction that should be used to compare
9717 the first two arguments, and COND is the condition it should test.
9718 TARGET, if nonnull, suggests a good place to put the result. */
9720 static rtx
9721 mips_expand_builtin_movtf (enum mips_builtin_type type,
9722 enum insn_code icode, enum mips_fp_condition cond,
9723 rtx target, tree arglist)
9725 rtx cmp_result, op0, op1;
9727 cmp_result = mips_prepare_builtin_target (icode, 0, 0);
9728 op0 = mips_prepare_builtin_arg (icode, 1, &arglist);
9729 op1 = mips_prepare_builtin_arg (icode, 2, &arglist);
9730 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode) (cmp_result, op0, op1, GEN_INT (cond)));
9732 icode = CODE_FOR_mips_cond_move_tf_ps;
9733 target = mips_prepare_builtin_target (icode, 0, target);
9734 if (type == MIPS_BUILTIN_MOVT)
9736 op1 = mips_prepare_builtin_arg (icode, 2, &arglist);
9737 op0 = mips_prepare_builtin_arg (icode, 1, &arglist);
9739 else
9741 op0 = mips_prepare_builtin_arg (icode, 1, &arglist);
9742 op1 = mips_prepare_builtin_arg (icode, 2, &arglist);
9744 emit_insn (gen_mips_cond_move_tf_ps (target, op0, op1, cmp_result));
9745 return target;
9748 /* Expand a comparison builtin of type BUILTIN_TYPE. ICODE is the code
9749 of the comparison instruction and COND is the condition it should test.
9750 ARGLIST is the list of function arguments and TARGET, if nonnull,
9751 suggests a good place to put the boolean result. */
9753 static rtx
9754 mips_expand_builtin_compare (enum mips_builtin_type builtin_type,
9755 enum insn_code icode, enum mips_fp_condition cond,
9756 rtx target, tree arglist)
9758 rtx label1, label2, if_then_else;
9759 rtx pat, cmp_result, ops[MAX_RECOG_OPERANDS];
9760 rtx target_if_equal, target_if_unequal;
9761 int cmp_value, i;
9763 if (target == 0 || GET_MODE (target) != SImode)
9764 target = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
9766 /* Prepare the operands to the comparison. */
9767 cmp_result = mips_prepare_builtin_target (icode, 0, 0);
9768 for (i = 1; i < insn_data[icode].n_operands - 1; i++)
9769 ops[i] = mips_prepare_builtin_arg (icode, i, &arglist);
9771 switch (insn_data[icode].n_operands)
9773 case 4:
9774 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (cmp_result, ops[1], ops[2], GEN_INT (cond));
9775 break;
9777 case 6:
9778 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (cmp_result, ops[1], ops[2],
9779 ops[3], ops[4], GEN_INT (cond));
9780 break;
9782 default:
9783 gcc_unreachable ();
9786 /* If the comparison sets more than one register, we define the result
9787 to be 0 if all registers are false and -1 if all registers are true.
9788 The value of the complete result is indeterminate otherwise. It is
9789 possible to test individual registers using SUBREGs.
9791 Set up CMP_RESULT, CMP_VALUE, TARGET_IF_EQUAL and TARGET_IF_UNEQUAL so
9792 that the result should be TARGET_IF_EQUAL if (EQ CMP_RESULT CMP_VALUE)
9793 and TARGET_IF_UNEQUAL otherwise. */
9794 if (builtin_type == MIPS_BUILTIN_CMP_ALL)
9796 cmp_value = -1;
9797 target_if_equal = const1_rtx;
9798 target_if_unequal = const0_rtx;
9800 else
9802 cmp_value = 0;
9803 target_if_equal = const0_rtx;
9804 target_if_unequal = const1_rtx;
9805 if (builtin_type == MIPS_BUILTIN_CMP_UPPER)
9806 cmp_result = simplify_gen_subreg (CCmode, cmp_result, CCV2mode, 4);
9807 else if (builtin_type == MIPS_BUILTIN_CMP_LOWER)
9808 cmp_result = simplify_gen_subreg (CCmode, cmp_result, CCV2mode, 0);
9811 /* First assume that CMP_RESULT == CMP_VALUE. */
9812 emit_move_insn (target, target_if_equal);
9814 /* Branch to LABEL1 if CMP_RESULT != CMP_VALUE. */
9815 emit_insn (pat);
9816 label1 = gen_label_rtx ();
9817 label2 = gen_label_rtx ();
9818 if_then_else
9819 = gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (VOIDmode,
9820 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (NE, GET_MODE (cmp_result),
9821 cmp_result, GEN_INT (cmp_value)),
9822 gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (VOIDmode, label1), pc_rtx);
9823 emit_jump_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, pc_rtx, if_then_else));
9824 emit_jump_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, pc_rtx,
9825 gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (VOIDmode, label2)));
9826 emit_barrier ();
9827 emit_label (label1);
9829 /* Fix TARGET for CMP_RESULT != CMP_VALUE. */
9830 emit_move_insn (target, target_if_unequal);
9831 emit_label (label2);
9833 return target;
9836 #include "gt-mips.h"